| /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB. |
| |
| Copyright (C) 1986-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc. |
| |
| This file is part of GDB. |
| |
| This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify |
| it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by |
| the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or |
| (at your option) any later version. |
| |
| This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, |
| but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of |
| MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the |
| GNU General Public License for more details. |
| |
| You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License |
| along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */ |
| |
| #include "defs.h" |
| #include "arch-utils.h" |
| #include <ctype.h> |
| #include "hashtab.h" |
| #include "symtab.h" |
| #include "frame.h" |
| #include "breakpoint.h" |
| #include "tracepoint.h" |
| #include "gdbtypes.h" |
| #include "expression.h" |
| #include "gdbcore.h" |
| #include "gdbcmd.h" |
| #include "value.h" |
| #include "command.h" |
| #include "inferior.h" |
| #include "infrun.h" |
| #include "gdbthread.h" |
| #include "target.h" |
| #include "language.h" |
| #include "gdb-demangle.h" |
| #include "filenames.h" |
| #include "annotate.h" |
| #include "symfile.h" |
| #include "objfiles.h" |
| #include "source.h" |
| #include "linespec.h" |
| #include "completer.h" |
| #include "ui-out.h" |
| #include "cli/cli-script.h" |
| #include "block.h" |
| #include "solib.h" |
| #include "solist.h" |
| #include "observable.h" |
| #include "memattr.h" |
| #include "ada-lang.h" |
| #include "top.h" |
| #include "valprint.h" |
| #include "jit.h" |
| #include "parser-defs.h" |
| #include "gdbsupport/gdb_regex.h" |
| #include "probe.h" |
| #include "cli/cli-utils.h" |
| #include "stack.h" |
| #include "ax-gdb.h" |
| #include "dummy-frame.h" |
| #include "interps.h" |
| #include "gdbsupport/format.h" |
| #include "thread-fsm.h" |
| #include "tid-parse.h" |
| #include "cli/cli-style.h" |
| #include "cli/cli-decode.h" |
| |
| /* readline include files */ |
| #include "readline/tilde.h" |
| |
| /* readline defines this. */ |
| #undef savestring |
| |
| #include "mi/mi-common.h" |
| #include "extension.h" |
| #include <algorithm> |
| #include "progspace-and-thread.h" |
| #include "gdbsupport/array-view.h" |
| #include "gdbsupport/gdb_optional.h" |
| |
| /* Prototypes for local functions. */ |
| |
| static void map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *, |
| gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)>); |
| |
| static void breakpoint_re_set_default (base_breakpoint *); |
| |
| static void |
| create_sals_from_location_default (struct event_location *location, |
| struct linespec_result *canonical); |
| |
| static void create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *, |
| struct linespec_result *, |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>, |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>, |
| enum bptype, |
| enum bpdisp, int, int, |
| int, |
| int, int, int, unsigned); |
| |
| static std::vector<symtab_and_line> decode_location_default |
| (struct breakpoint *b, struct event_location *location, |
| struct program_space *search_pspace); |
| |
| static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint |
| (const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals); |
| |
| static void mention (const breakpoint *); |
| |
| static breakpoint *add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&b); |
| |
| static breakpoint *add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&b); |
| |
| static struct breakpoint * |
| momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig, |
| enum bptype type, |
| int loc_enabled); |
| |
| static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int); |
| |
| static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, |
| CORE_ADDR bpaddr, |
| enum bptype bptype); |
| |
| static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, |
| struct bp_location *loc2); |
| |
| static int breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, |
| struct bp_location *loc2, |
| bool sw_hw_bps_match = false); |
| |
| static int breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl, |
| const struct address_space *aspace, |
| CORE_ADDR addr); |
| |
| static int breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *, |
| const address_space *, |
| CORE_ADDR, int); |
| |
| static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *); |
| static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, enum remove_bp_reason); |
| |
| static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat *bs); |
| |
| static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void); |
| |
| static int hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *); |
| |
| static int hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except, |
| enum bptype type, |
| int *other_type_used); |
| |
| static void enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp, |
| int count); |
| |
| static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **loc); |
| |
| static std::vector<symtab_and_line> bkpt_probe_decode_location |
| (struct breakpoint *b, |
| struct event_location *location, |
| struct program_space *search_pspace); |
| |
| static bool bl_address_is_meaningful (bp_location *loc); |
| |
| /* update_global_location_list's modes of operation wrt to whether to |
| insert locations now. */ |
| enum ugll_insert_mode |
| { |
| /* Don't insert any breakpoint locations into the inferior, only |
| remove already-inserted locations that no longer should be |
| inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or breakpoints |
| should specify this mode, so that deleting a breakpoint doesn't |
| have the side effect of inserting the locations of other |
| breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted |
| returns true on them. |
| |
| This behavior is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g., |
| after an exec, while the target still has execution, but |
| breakpoint shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT* |
| be restored to the new image; or before detaching, where the |
| target still has execution and wants to delete breakpoints from |
| GDB's lists, and all breakpoints had already been removed from |
| the inferior. */ |
| UGLL_DONT_INSERT, |
| |
| /* May insert breakpoints iff breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now |
| claims breakpoints should be inserted now. */ |
| UGLL_MAY_INSERT, |
| |
| /* Insert locations now, irrespective of |
| breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now. E.g., say all threads are |
| stopped right now, and the user did "continue". We need to |
| insert breakpoints _before_ resuming the target, but |
| UGLL_MAY_INSERT wouldn't insert them, because |
| breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now returns false at that point, |
| as no thread is running yet. */ |
| UGLL_INSERT |
| }; |
| |
| static void update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode); |
| |
| static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode); |
| |
| static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void); |
| |
| static void trace_pass_command (const char *, int); |
| |
| static void set_tracepoint_count (int num); |
| |
| static bool is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b); |
| |
| /* Return 1 if B refers to a static tracepoint set by marker ("-m"), zero |
| otherwise. */ |
| |
| static int strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b); |
| |
| static void bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location |
| (struct event_location *location, |
| struct linespec_result *canonical); |
| static void tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location |
| (struct event_location *location, |
| struct linespec_result *canonical); |
| |
| const struct breakpoint_ops base_breakpoint_ops = |
| { |
| create_sals_from_location_default, |
| create_breakpoints_sal, |
| }; |
| |
| /* Breakpoints set on probes. */ |
| static const struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops = |
| { |
| bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location, |
| create_breakpoints_sal, |
| }; |
| |
| /* Tracepoints set on probes. */ |
| static const struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops = |
| { |
| tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location, |
| create_breakpoints_sal, |
| }; |
| |
| /* Implementation of abstract dtors. These must exist to satisfy the |
| linker. */ |
| |
| breakpoint::~breakpoint () |
| { |
| } |
| |
| base_breakpoint::~base_breakpoint () |
| { |
| } |
| |
| catchpoint::~catchpoint () |
| { |
| } |
| |
| /* The structure to be used in regular breakpoints. */ |
| struct ordinary_breakpoint : public base_breakpoint |
| { |
| using base_breakpoint::base_breakpoint; |
| |
| int resources_needed (const struct bp_location *) override; |
| enum print_stop_action print_it (const bpstat *bs) const override; |
| void print_mention () const override; |
| void print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const override; |
| }; |
| |
| /* Internal breakpoints. */ |
| struct internal_breakpoint : public base_breakpoint |
| { |
| internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, |
| enum bptype type, CORE_ADDR address) |
| : base_breakpoint (gdbarch, type) |
| { |
| symtab_and_line sal; |
| sal.pc = address; |
| sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc); |
| sal.pspace = current_program_space; |
| add_location (sal); |
| |
| pspace = current_program_space; |
| disposition = disp_donttouch; |
| } |
| |
| void re_set () override; |
| void check_status (struct bpstat *bs) override; |
| enum print_stop_action print_it (const bpstat *bs) const override; |
| void print_mention () const override; |
| }; |
| |
| /* Momentary breakpoints. */ |
| struct momentary_breakpoint : public base_breakpoint |
| { |
| using base_breakpoint::base_breakpoint; |
| |
| void re_set () override; |
| void check_status (struct bpstat *bs) override; |
| enum print_stop_action print_it (const bpstat *bs) const override; |
| void print_mention () const override; |
| }; |
| |
| /* DPrintf breakpoints. */ |
| struct dprintf_breakpoint : public ordinary_breakpoint |
| { |
| using ordinary_breakpoint::ordinary_breakpoint; |
| |
| void re_set () override; |
| int breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, |
| const address_space *aspace, |
| CORE_ADDR bp_addr, |
| const target_waitstatus &ws) override; |
| void print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const override; |
| void after_condition_true (struct bpstat *bs) override; |
| }; |
| |
| /* Ranged breakpoints. */ |
| struct ranged_breakpoint : public ordinary_breakpoint |
| { |
| explicit ranged_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, |
| const symtab_and_line &sal_start, |
| int length, |
| event_location_up start_location, |
| event_location_up end_location) |
| : ordinary_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_hardware_breakpoint) |
| { |
| bp_location *bl = add_location (sal_start); |
| bl->length = length; |
| |
| disposition = disp_donttouch; |
| |
| location = std::move (start_location); |
| location_range_end = std::move (end_location); |
| } |
| |
| int breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, |
| const address_space *aspace, |
| CORE_ADDR bp_addr, |
| const target_waitstatus &ws) override; |
| int resources_needed (const struct bp_location *) override; |
| enum print_stop_action print_it (const bpstat *bs) const override; |
| bool print_one (bp_location **) const override; |
| void print_one_detail (struct ui_out *) const override; |
| void print_mention () const override; |
| void print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const override; |
| }; |
| |
| /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m'). */ |
| struct static_marker_tracepoint : public tracepoint |
| { |
| using tracepoint::tracepoint; |
| |
| std::vector<symtab_and_line> decode_location |
| (struct event_location *location, |
| struct program_space *search_pspace) override; |
| }; |
| |
| /* The style in which to perform a dynamic printf. This is a user |
| option because different output options have different tradeoffs; |
| if GDB does the printing, there is better error handling if there |
| is a problem with any of the arguments, but using an inferior |
| function lets you have special-purpose printers and sending of |
| output to the same place as compiled-in print functions. */ |
| |
| static const char dprintf_style_gdb[] = "gdb"; |
| static const char dprintf_style_call[] = "call"; |
| static const char dprintf_style_agent[] = "agent"; |
| static const char *const dprintf_style_enums[] = { |
| dprintf_style_gdb, |
| dprintf_style_call, |
| dprintf_style_agent, |
| NULL |
| }; |
| static const char *dprintf_style = dprintf_style_gdb; |
| |
| /* The function to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to |
| call into the inferior. The value is simply a string that is |
| copied into the command, so it can be anything that GDB can |
| evaluate to a callable address, not necessarily a function name. */ |
| |
| static std::string dprintf_function = "printf"; |
| |
| /* The channel to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to |
| call into the inferior; if a nonempty string, it will be passed to |
| the call as the first argument, with the format string as the |
| second. As with the dprintf function, this can be anything that |
| GDB knows how to evaluate, so in addition to common choices like |
| "stderr", this could be an app-specific expression like |
| "mystreams[curlogger]". */ |
| |
| static std::string dprintf_channel; |
| |
| /* True if dprintf commands should continue to operate even if GDB |
| has disconnected. */ |
| static bool disconnected_dprintf = true; |
| |
| struct command_line * |
| breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| return b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL; |
| } |
| |
| /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the |
| current breakpoint. */ |
| |
| static bool breakpoint_proceeded; |
| |
| const char * |
| bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp) |
| { |
| /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and |
| represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at |
| a breakpoint. */ |
| static const char * const bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"}; |
| |
| return bpdisps[(int) disp]; |
| } |
| |
| /* Prototypes for exported functions. */ |
| /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even |
| if such is available. */ |
| static int can_use_hw_watchpoints; |
| |
| static void |
| show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty, |
| struct cmd_list_element *c, |
| const char *value) |
| { |
| gdb_printf (file, |
| _("Debugger's willingness to use " |
| "watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"), |
| value); |
| } |
| |
| /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints. |
| If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints |
| for unrecognized breakpoint locations. |
| If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */ |
| static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support; |
| static void |
| show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty, |
| struct cmd_list_element *c, |
| const char *value) |
| { |
| gdb_printf (file, |
| _("Debugger's behavior regarding " |
| "pending breakpoints is %s.\n"), |
| value); |
| } |
| |
| /* If true, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints |
| set with "break" but falling in read-only memory. |
| If false, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically |
| use hardware breakpoints. */ |
| static bool automatic_hardware_breakpoints; |
| static void |
| show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty, |
| struct cmd_list_element *c, |
| const char *value) |
| { |
| gdb_printf (file, |
| _("Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"), |
| value); |
| } |
| |
| /* If on, GDB keeps breakpoints inserted even if the inferior is |
| stopped, and immediately inserts any new breakpoints as soon as |
| they're created. If off (default), GDB keeps breakpoints off of |
| the target as long as possible. That is, it delays inserting |
| breakpoints until the next resume, and removes them again when the |
| target fully stops. This is a bit safer in case GDB crashes while |
| processing user input. */ |
| static bool always_inserted_mode = false; |
| |
| static void |
| show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty, |
| struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value) |
| { |
| gdb_printf (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"), |
| value); |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| int |
| breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now (void) |
| { |
| if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())) |
| { |
| /* If breakpoints are global, they should be inserted even if no |
| thread under gdb's control is running, or even if there are |
| no threads under GDB's control yet. */ |
| return 1; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (always_inserted_mode) |
| { |
| /* The user wants breakpoints inserted even if all threads |
| are stopped. */ |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ()) |
| if (inf->has_execution () |
| && threads_are_executing (inf->process_target ())) |
| return 1; |
| |
| /* Don't remove breakpoints yet if, even though all threads are |
| stopped, we still have events to process. */ |
| for (thread_info *tp : all_non_exited_threads ()) |
| if (tp->resumed () && tp->has_pending_waitstatus ()) |
| return 1; |
| } |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| static const char condition_evaluation_both[] = "host or target"; |
| |
| /* Modes for breakpoint condition evaluation. */ |
| static const char condition_evaluation_auto[] = "auto"; |
| static const char condition_evaluation_host[] = "host"; |
| static const char condition_evaluation_target[] = "target"; |
| static const char *const condition_evaluation_enums[] = { |
| condition_evaluation_auto, |
| condition_evaluation_host, |
| condition_evaluation_target, |
| NULL |
| }; |
| |
| /* Global that holds the current mode for breakpoint condition evaluation. */ |
| static const char *condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_auto; |
| |
| /* Global that we use to display information to the user (gets its value from |
| condition_evaluation_mode_1. */ |
| static const char *condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_auto; |
| |
| /* Translate a condition evaluation mode MODE into either "host" |
| or "target". This is used mostly to translate from "auto" to the |
| real setting that is being used. It returns the translated |
| evaluation mode. */ |
| |
| static const char * |
| translate_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *mode) |
| { |
| if (mode == condition_evaluation_auto) |
| { |
| if (target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) |
| return condition_evaluation_target; |
| else |
| return condition_evaluation_host; |
| } |
| else |
| return mode; |
| } |
| |
| /* Discovers what condition_evaluation_auto translates to. */ |
| |
| static const char * |
| breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (void) |
| { |
| return translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode); |
| } |
| |
| /* Return true if GDB should evaluate breakpoint conditions or false |
| otherwise. */ |
| |
| static int |
| gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p (void) |
| { |
| const char *mode = breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (); |
| |
| return (mode == condition_evaluation_host); |
| } |
| |
| /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */ |
| static int executing_breakpoint_commands; |
| |
| /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */ |
| static int overlay_events_enabled; |
| |
| /* See description in breakpoint.h. */ |
| bool target_exact_watchpoints = false; |
| |
| /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints. |
| ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statement deletes the |
| current breakpoint. */ |
| |
| #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \ |
| for (B = breakpoint_chain; \ |
| B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \ |
| B = TMP) |
| |
| /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */ |
| |
| static struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain; |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| breakpoint_range |
| all_breakpoints () |
| { |
| return breakpoint_range (breakpoint_chain); |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| breakpoint_safe_range |
| all_breakpoints_safe () |
| { |
| return breakpoint_safe_range (all_breakpoints ()); |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| tracepoint_range |
| all_tracepoints () |
| { |
| return tracepoint_range (breakpoint_chain); |
| } |
| |
| /* Array is sorted by bp_location_is_less_than - primarily by the ADDRESS. */ |
| |
| static std::vector<bp_location *> bp_locations; |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| const std::vector<bp_location *> & |
| all_bp_locations () |
| { |
| return bp_locations; |
| } |
| |
| /* Range to iterate over breakpoint locations at a given address. */ |
| |
| struct bp_locations_at_addr_range |
| { |
| using iterator = std::vector<bp_location *>::iterator; |
| |
| bp_locations_at_addr_range (CORE_ADDR addr) |
| { |
| struct compare |
| { |
| bool operator() (const bp_location *loc, CORE_ADDR addr_) const |
| { return loc->address < addr_; } |
| |
| bool operator() (CORE_ADDR addr_, const bp_location *loc) const |
| { return addr_ < loc->address; } |
| }; |
| |
| auto it_pair = std::equal_range (bp_locations.begin (), bp_locations.end (), |
| addr, compare ()); |
| |
| m_begin = it_pair.first; |
| m_end = it_pair.second; |
| } |
| |
| iterator begin () const |
| { return m_begin; } |
| |
| iterator end () const |
| { return m_end; } |
| |
| private: |
| iterator m_begin; |
| iterator m_end; |
| }; |
| |
| /* Return a range to iterate over all breakpoint locations exactly at address |
| ADDR. |
| |
| If it's needed to iterate multiple times on the same range, it's possible |
| to save the range in a local variable and use it multiple times: |
| |
| auto range = all_bp_locations_at_addr (addr); |
| |
| for (bp_location *loc : range) |
| // use loc |
| |
| for (bp_location *loc : range) |
| // use loc |
| |
| This saves a bit of time, as it avoids re-doing the binary searches to find |
| the range's boundaries. Just remember not to change the bp_locations vector |
| in the mean time, as it could make the range's iterators stale. */ |
| |
| static bp_locations_at_addr_range |
| all_bp_locations_at_addr (CORE_ADDR addr) |
| { |
| return bp_locations_at_addr_range (addr); |
| } |
| |
| /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and |
| ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid |
| result from bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly |
| limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to scan for shadow bytes for |
| an address you need to read. */ |
| |
| static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max; |
| |
| /* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS |
| + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of |
| BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow. |
| You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to |
| scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */ |
| |
| static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max; |
| |
| /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked |
| from the bp_locations array, but for which a hit may still be |
| reported by a target. */ |
| static std::vector<bp_location *> moribund_locations; |
| |
| /* Number of last breakpoint made. */ |
| |
| static int breakpoint_count; |
| |
| /* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that |
| created breakpoints. If the last (break-like) command created more |
| than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT |
| and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one. */ |
| static int prev_breakpoint_count; |
| |
| /* Number of last tracepoint made. */ |
| |
| static int tracepoint_count; |
| |
| static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist; |
| static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist; |
| struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist; |
| |
| /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */ |
| static int |
| breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled); |
| } |
| |
| /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */ |
| |
| static void |
| set_breakpoint_count (int num) |
| { |
| prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count; |
| breakpoint_count = num; |
| set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num); |
| } |
| |
| /* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current |
| breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint. */ |
| static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count; |
| |
| /* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first |
| breakpoint made. */ |
| |
| scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::scoped_rbreak_breakpoints () |
| { |
| rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count; |
| } |
| |
| /* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last |
| breakpoint made. */ |
| |
| scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::~scoped_rbreak_breakpoints () |
| { |
| prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count; |
| } |
| |
| /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */ |
| |
| void |
| clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| b->hit_count = 0; |
| } |
| |
| |
| /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL |
| if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */ |
| |
| struct breakpoint * |
| get_breakpoint (int num) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| if (b->number == num) |
| return b; |
| |
| return nullptr; |
| } |
| |
| |
| |
| /* Mark locations as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports |
| evaluating conditions on its side. */ |
| |
| static void |
| mark_breakpoint_modified (struct breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| /* This is only meaningful if the target is |
| evaluating conditions and if the user has |
| opted for condition evaluation on the target's |
| side. */ |
| if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p () |
| || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) |
| return; |
| |
| if (!is_breakpoint (b)) |
| return; |
| |
| for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ()) |
| loc->condition_changed = condition_modified; |
| } |
| |
| /* Mark location as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports |
| evaluating conditions on its side. */ |
| |
| static void |
| mark_breakpoint_location_modified (struct bp_location *loc) |
| { |
| /* This is only meaningful if the target is |
| evaluating conditions and if the user has |
| opted for condition evaluation on the target's |
| side. */ |
| if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p () |
| || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) |
| |
| return; |
| |
| if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner)) |
| return; |
| |
| loc->condition_changed = condition_modified; |
| } |
| |
| /* Sets the condition-evaluation mode using the static global |
| condition_evaluation_mode. */ |
| |
| static void |
| set_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *args, int from_tty, |
| struct cmd_list_element *c) |
| { |
| const char *old_mode, *new_mode; |
| |
| if ((condition_evaluation_mode_1 == condition_evaluation_target) |
| && !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) |
| { |
| condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_mode; |
| warning (_("Target does not support breakpoint condition evaluation.\n" |
| "Using host evaluation mode instead.")); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| new_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode_1); |
| old_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode); |
| |
| /* Flip the switch. Flip it even if OLD_MODE == NEW_MODE as one of the |
| settings was "auto". */ |
| condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_mode_1; |
| |
| /* Only update the mode if the user picked a different one. */ |
| if (new_mode != old_mode) |
| { |
| /* If the user switched to a different evaluation mode, we |
| need to synch the changes with the target as follows: |
| |
| "host" -> "target": Send all (valid) conditions to the target. |
| "target" -> "host": Remove all the conditions from the target. |
| */ |
| |
| if (new_mode == condition_evaluation_target) |
| { |
| /* Mark everything modified and synch conditions with the |
| target. */ |
| for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ()) |
| mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* Manually mark non-duplicate locations to synch conditions |
| with the target. We do this to remove all the conditions the |
| target knows about. */ |
| for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ()) |
| if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->inserted) |
| loc->needs_update = 1; |
| } |
| |
| /* Do the update. */ |
| update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); |
| } |
| |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| /* Shows the current mode of breakpoint condition evaluation. Explicitly shows |
| what "auto" is translating to. */ |
| |
| static void |
| show_condition_evaluation_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty, |
| struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value) |
| { |
| if (condition_evaluation_mode == condition_evaluation_auto) |
| gdb_printf (file, |
| _("Breakpoint condition evaluation " |
| "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"), |
| value, |
| breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ()); |
| else |
| gdb_printf (file, _("Breakpoint condition evaluation mode is %s.\n"), |
| value); |
| } |
| |
| /* Parse COND_STRING in the context of LOC and set as the condition |
| expression of LOC. BP_NUM is the number of LOC's owner, LOC_NUM is |
| the number of LOC within its owner. In case of parsing error, mark |
| LOC as DISABLED_BY_COND. In case of success, unset DISABLED_BY_COND. */ |
| |
| static void |
| set_breakpoint_location_condition (const char *cond_string, bp_location *loc, |
| int bp_num, int loc_num) |
| { |
| bool has_junk = false; |
| try |
| { |
| expression_up new_exp = parse_exp_1 (&cond_string, loc->address, |
| block_for_pc (loc->address), 0); |
| if (*cond_string != 0) |
| has_junk = true; |
| else |
| { |
| loc->cond = std::move (new_exp); |
| if (loc->disabled_by_cond && loc->enabled) |
| gdb_printf (_("Breakpoint %d's condition is now valid at " |
| "location %d, enabling.\n"), |
| bp_num, loc_num); |
| |
| loc->disabled_by_cond = false; |
| } |
| } |
| catch (const gdb_exception_error &e) |
| { |
| if (loc->enabled) |
| { |
| /* Warn if a user-enabled location is now becoming disabled-by-cond. |
| BP_NUM is 0 if the breakpoint is being defined for the first |
| time using the "break ... if ..." command, and non-zero if |
| already defined. */ |
| if (bp_num != 0) |
| warning (_("failed to validate condition at location %d.%d, " |
| "disabling:\n %s"), bp_num, loc_num, e.what ()); |
| else |
| warning (_("failed to validate condition at location %d, " |
| "disabling:\n %s"), loc_num, e.what ()); |
| } |
| |
| loc->disabled_by_cond = true; |
| } |
| |
| if (has_junk) |
| error (_("Garbage '%s' follows condition"), cond_string); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, const char *exp, |
| int from_tty, bool force) |
| { |
| if (*exp == 0) |
| { |
| b->cond_string.reset (); |
| |
| if (is_watchpoint (b)) |
| static_cast<watchpoint *> (b)->cond_exp.reset (); |
| else |
| { |
| int loc_num = 1; |
| for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ()) |
| { |
| loc->cond.reset (); |
| if (loc->disabled_by_cond && loc->enabled) |
| gdb_printf (_("Breakpoint %d's condition is now valid at " |
| "location %d, enabling.\n"), |
| b->number, loc_num); |
| loc->disabled_by_cond = false; |
| loc_num++; |
| |
| /* No need to free the condition agent expression |
| bytecode (if we have one). We will handle this |
| when we go through update_global_location_list. */ |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (from_tty) |
| gdb_printf (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (is_watchpoint (b)) |
| { |
| innermost_block_tracker tracker; |
| const char *arg = exp; |
| expression_up new_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0, &tracker); |
| if (*arg != 0) |
| error (_("Junk at end of expression")); |
| watchpoint *w = static_cast<watchpoint *> (b); |
| w->cond_exp = std::move (new_exp); |
| w->cond_exp_valid_block = tracker.block (); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* Parse and set condition expressions. We make two passes. |
| In the first, we parse the condition string to see if it |
| is valid in at least one location. If so, the condition |
| would be accepted. So we go ahead and set the locations' |
| conditions. In case no valid case is found, we throw |
| the error and the condition string will be rejected. |
| This two-pass approach is taken to avoid setting the |
| state of locations in case of a reject. */ |
| for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ()) |
| { |
| try |
| { |
| const char *arg = exp; |
| parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address, |
| block_for_pc (loc->address), 0); |
| if (*arg != 0) |
| error (_("Junk at end of expression")); |
| break; |
| } |
| catch (const gdb_exception_error &e) |
| { |
| /* Condition string is invalid. If this happens to |
| be the last loc, abandon (if not forced) or continue |
| (if forced). */ |
| if (loc->next == nullptr && !force) |
| throw; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* If we reach here, the condition is valid at some locations. */ |
| int loc_num = 1; |
| for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ()) |
| { |
| set_breakpoint_location_condition (exp, loc, b->number, loc_num); |
| loc_num++; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* We know that the new condition parsed successfully. The |
| condition string of the breakpoint can be safely updated. */ |
| b->cond_string = make_unique_xstrdup (exp); |
| b->condition_not_parsed = 0; |
| } |
| mark_breakpoint_modified (b); |
| |
| gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b); |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| void |
| set_breakpoint_condition (int bpnum, const char *exp, int from_tty, |
| bool force) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| if (b->number == bpnum) |
| { |
| /* Check if this breakpoint has a "stop" method implemented in an |
| extension language. This method and conditions entered into GDB |
| from the CLI are mutually exclusive. */ |
| const struct extension_language_defn *extlang |
| = get_breakpoint_cond_ext_lang (b, EXT_LANG_NONE); |
| |
| if (extlang != NULL) |
| { |
| error (_("Only one stop condition allowed. There is currently" |
| " a %s stop condition defined for this breakpoint."), |
| ext_lang_capitalized_name (extlang)); |
| } |
| set_breakpoint_condition (b, exp, from_tty, force); |
| |
| if (is_breakpoint (b)) |
| update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); |
| |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bpnum); |
| } |
| |
| /* The options for the "condition" command. */ |
| |
| struct condition_command_opts |
| { |
| /* For "-force". */ |
| bool force_condition = false; |
| }; |
| |
| static const gdb::option::option_def condition_command_option_defs[] = { |
| |
| gdb::option::flag_option_def<condition_command_opts> { |
| "force", |
| [] (condition_command_opts *opts) { return &opts->force_condition; }, |
| N_("Set the condition even if it is invalid for all current locations."), |
| }, |
| |
| }; |
| |
| /* Create an option_def_group for the "condition" options, with |
| CC_OPTS as context. */ |
| |
| static inline gdb::option::option_def_group |
| make_condition_command_options_def_group (condition_command_opts *cc_opts) |
| { |
| return {{condition_command_option_defs}, cc_opts}; |
| } |
| |
| /* Completion for the "condition" command. */ |
| |
| static void |
| condition_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd, |
| completion_tracker &tracker, |
| const char *text, const char * /*word*/) |
| { |
| bool has_no_arguments = (*text == '\0'); |
| condition_command_opts cc_opts; |
| const auto group = make_condition_command_options_def_group (&cc_opts); |
| if (gdb::option::complete_options |
| (tracker, &text, gdb::option::PROCESS_OPTIONS_UNKNOWN_IS_ERROR, group)) |
| return; |
| |
| text = skip_spaces (text); |
| const char *space = skip_to_space (text); |
| if (*space == '\0') |
| { |
| int len; |
| |
| if (text[0] == '$') |
| { |
| tracker.advance_custom_word_point_by (1); |
| /* We don't support completion of history indices. */ |
| if (!isdigit (text[1])) |
| complete_internalvar (tracker, &text[1]); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| /* Suggest the "-force" flag if no arguments are given. If |
| arguments were passed, they either already include the flag, |
| or we are beyond the point of suggesting it because it's |
| positionally the first argument. */ |
| if (has_no_arguments) |
| gdb::option::complete_on_all_options (tracker, group); |
| |
| /* We're completing the breakpoint number. */ |
| len = strlen (text); |
| |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| { |
| char number[50]; |
| |
| xsnprintf (number, sizeof (number), "%d", b->number); |
| |
| if (strncmp (number, text, len) == 0) |
| tracker.add_completion (make_unique_xstrdup (number)); |
| } |
| |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| /* We're completing the expression part. Skip the breakpoint num. */ |
| const char *exp_start = skip_spaces (space); |
| tracker.advance_custom_word_point_by (exp_start - text); |
| text = exp_start; |
| const char *word = advance_to_expression_complete_word_point (tracker, text); |
| expression_completer (cmd, tracker, text, word); |
| } |
| |
| /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */ |
| |
| static void |
| condition_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) |
| { |
| const char *p; |
| int bnum; |
| |
| if (arg == 0) |
| error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number")); |
| |
| p = arg; |
| |
| /* Check if the "-force" flag was passed. */ |
| condition_command_opts cc_opts; |
| const auto group = make_condition_command_options_def_group (&cc_opts); |
| gdb::option::process_options |
| (&p, gdb::option::PROCESS_OPTIONS_UNKNOWN_IS_ERROR, group); |
| |
| bnum = get_number (&p); |
| if (bnum == 0) |
| error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg); |
| |
| set_breakpoint_condition (bnum, p, from_tty, cc_opts.force_condition); |
| } |
| |
| /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable |
| only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints. |
| Throw if any such commands is found. */ |
| |
| static void |
| check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands) |
| { |
| struct command_line *c; |
| |
| for (c = commands; c; c = c->next) |
| { |
| if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control) |
| error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can " |
| "only be used for tracepoints")); |
| |
| check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_0.get ()); |
| check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_1.get ()); |
| |
| /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment |
| lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for |
| command directly. */ |
| if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line) |
| error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints")); |
| |
| if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line) |
| error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints")); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| struct longjmp_breakpoint : public momentary_breakpoint |
| { |
| using momentary_breakpoint::momentary_breakpoint; |
| |
| ~longjmp_breakpoint () override; |
| }; |
| |
| /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */ |
| |
| static bool |
| is_tracepoint_type (bptype type) |
| { |
| return (type == bp_tracepoint |
| || type == bp_fast_tracepoint |
| || type == bp_static_tracepoint |
| || type == bp_static_marker_tracepoint); |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| bool |
| is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| return is_tracepoint_type (b->type); |
| } |
| |
| /* Factory function to create an appropriate instance of breakpoint given |
| TYPE. */ |
| |
| template<typename... Arg> |
| static std::unique_ptr<base_breakpoint> |
| new_breakpoint_from_type (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, bptype type, |
| Arg&&... args) |
| { |
| base_breakpoint *b; |
| |
| switch (type) |
| { |
| case bp_breakpoint: |
| case bp_hardware_breakpoint: |
| b = new ordinary_breakpoint (gdbarch, type, |
| std::forward<Arg> (args)...); |
| break; |
| |
| case bp_fast_tracepoint: |
| case bp_static_tracepoint: |
| case bp_tracepoint: |
| b = new tracepoint (gdbarch, type, |
| std::forward<Arg> (args)...); |
| break; |
| |
| case bp_static_marker_tracepoint: |
| b = new static_marker_tracepoint (gdbarch, type, |
| std::forward<Arg> (args)...); |
| break; |
| |
| case bp_dprintf: |
| b = new dprintf_breakpoint (gdbarch, type, |
| std::forward<Arg> (args)...); |
| break; |
| |
| default: |
| gdb_assert_not_reached ("invalid type"); |
| } |
| |
| return std::unique_ptr<base_breakpoint> (b); |
| } |
| |
| /* A helper function that validates that COMMANDS are valid for a |
| breakpoint. This function will throw an exception if a problem is |
| found. */ |
| |
| static void |
| validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, |
| struct command_line *commands) |
| { |
| if (is_tracepoint (b)) |
| { |
| struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b; |
| struct command_line *c; |
| struct command_line *while_stepping = 0; |
| |
| /* Reset the while-stepping step count. The previous commands |
| might have included a while-stepping action, while the new |
| ones might not. */ |
| t->step_count = 0; |
| |
| /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is |
| valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one |
| while-stepping element, and that the while-stepping's body |
| has valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping. |
| We also need to validate the tracepoint action line in the |
| context of the tracepoint --- validate_actionline actually |
| has side effects, like setting the tracepoint's |
| while-stepping STEP_COUNT, in addition to checking if the |
| collect/teval actions parse and make sense in the |
| tracepoint's context. */ |
| for (c = commands; c; c = c->next) |
| { |
| if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control) |
| { |
| if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint) |
| error (_("The 'while-stepping' command " |
| "cannot be used for fast tracepoint")); |
| else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint |
| || b->type == bp_static_marker_tracepoint) |
| error (_("The 'while-stepping' command " |
| "cannot be used for static tracepoint")); |
| |
| if (while_stepping) |
| error (_("The 'while-stepping' command " |
| "can be used only once")); |
| else |
| while_stepping = c; |
| } |
| |
| validate_actionline (c->line, b); |
| } |
| if (while_stepping) |
| { |
| struct command_line *c2; |
| |
| gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_list_1 == nullptr); |
| c2 = while_stepping->body_list_0.get (); |
| for (; c2; c2 = c2->next) |
| { |
| if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control) |
| error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested")); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR. The |
| caller is responsible for releasing the vector. */ |
| |
| std::vector<breakpoint *> |
| static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr) |
| { |
| std::vector<breakpoint *> found; |
| |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint |
| || b->type == bp_static_marker_tracepoint) |
| { |
| for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ()) |
| if (loc->address == addr) |
| found.push_back (b); |
| } |
| |
| return found; |
| } |
| |
| /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint, |
| validate that only allowed commands are included. */ |
| |
| void |
| breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b, |
| counted_command_line &&commands) |
| { |
| validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands.get ()); |
| |
| b->commands = std::move (commands); |
| gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b); |
| } |
| |
| /* Set the internal `silent' flag on the breakpoint. Note that this |
| is not the same as the "silent" that may appear in the breakpoint's |
| commands. */ |
| |
| void |
| breakpoint_set_silent (struct breakpoint *b, int silent) |
| { |
| int old_silent = b->silent; |
| |
| b->silent = silent; |
| if (old_silent != silent) |
| gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b); |
| } |
| |
| /* Set the thread for this breakpoint. If THREAD is -1, make the |
| breakpoint work for any thread. */ |
| |
| void |
| breakpoint_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b, int thread) |
| { |
| int old_thread = b->thread; |
| |
| b->thread = thread; |
| if (old_thread != thread) |
| gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b); |
| } |
| |
| /* Set the task for this breakpoint. If TASK is 0, make the |
| breakpoint work for any task. */ |
| |
| void |
| breakpoint_set_task (struct breakpoint *b, int task) |
| { |
| int old_task = b->task; |
| |
| b->task = task; |
| if (old_task != task) |
| gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| commands_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty, |
| struct command_line *control) |
| { |
| counted_command_line cmd; |
| /* cmd_read will be true once we have read cmd. Note that cmd might still be |
| NULL after the call to read_command_lines if the user provides an empty |
| list of command by just typing "end". */ |
| bool cmd_read = false; |
| |
| std::string new_arg; |
| |
| if (arg == NULL || !*arg) |
| { |
| /* Argument not explicitly given. Synthesize it. */ |
| if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1) |
| new_arg = string_printf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1, |
| breakpoint_count); |
| else if (breakpoint_count > 0) |
| new_arg = string_printf ("%d", breakpoint_count); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* Create a copy of ARG. This is needed because the "commands" |
| command may be coming from a script. In that case, the read |
| line buffer is going to be overwritten in the lambda of |
| 'map_breakpoint_numbers' below when reading the next line |
| before we are are done parsing the breakpoint numbers. */ |
| new_arg = arg; |
| } |
| arg = new_arg.c_str (); |
| |
| map_breakpoint_numbers |
| (arg, [&] (breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| if (!cmd_read) |
| { |
| gdb_assert (cmd == NULL); |
| if (control != NULL) |
| cmd = control->body_list_0; |
| else |
| { |
| std::string str |
| = string_printf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) " |
| "%s, one per line."), |
| arg); |
| |
| auto do_validate = [=] (const char *line) |
| { |
| validate_actionline (line, b); |
| }; |
| gdb::function_view<void (const char *)> validator; |
| if (is_tracepoint (b)) |
| validator = do_validate; |
| |
| cmd = read_command_lines (str.c_str (), from_tty, 1, validator); |
| } |
| cmd_read = true; |
| } |
| |
| /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to |
| do anything. */ |
| if (b->commands != cmd) |
| { |
| validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, cmd.get ()); |
| b->commands = cmd; |
| gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b); |
| } |
| }); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| commands_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) |
| { |
| commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL); |
| } |
| |
| /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from |
| input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure. |
| |
| This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands |
| that are part of if and while bodies. */ |
| enum command_control_type |
| commands_from_control_command (const char *arg, struct command_line *cmd) |
| { |
| commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd); |
| return simple_control; |
| } |
| |
| /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */ |
| |
| static int |
| bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl) |
| { |
| if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint) |
| return 0; |
| if (!bl->inserted) |
| return 0; |
| if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0) |
| /* BL isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */ |
| return 0; |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address |
| MEMADDR, by replacing a memory breakpoint with its shadowed |
| contents. |
| |
| If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with the of |
| the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffer. Otherwise, a |
| failed assertion internal error will be raised. */ |
| |
| static void |
| one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf, |
| const gdb_byte *writebuf_org, |
| ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len, |
| struct bp_target_info *target_info, |
| struct gdbarch *gdbarch) |
| { |
| /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */ |
| CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0; |
| int bp_size = 0; |
| int bptoffset = 0; |
| |
| if (!breakpoint_address_match (target_info->placed_address_space, 0, |
| current_program_space->aspace, 0)) |
| { |
| /* The breakpoint is inserted in a different address space. */ |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that |
| we need to copy. */ |
| bp_addr = target_info->placed_address; |
| bp_size = target_info->shadow_len; |
| |
| if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr) |
| { |
| /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we are |
| reading. */ |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len) |
| { |
| /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are |
| reading. */ |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| /* Offset within shadow_contents. */ |
| if (bp_addr < memaddr) |
| { |
| /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */ |
| bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr; |
| bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr; |
| bp_addr = memaddr; |
| } |
| |
| if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len) |
| { |
| /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */ |
| bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len); |
| } |
| |
| if (readbuf != NULL) |
| { |
| /* Verify that the readbuf buffer does not overlap with the |
| shadow_contents buffer. */ |
| gdb_assert (target_info->shadow_contents >= readbuf + len |
| || readbuf >= (target_info->shadow_contents |
| + target_info->shadow_len)); |
| |
| /* Update the read buffer with this inserted breakpoint's |
| shadow. */ |
| memcpy (readbuf + bp_addr - memaddr, |
| target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| const unsigned char *bp; |
| CORE_ADDR addr = target_info->reqstd_address; |
| int placed_size; |
| |
| /* Update the shadow with what we want to write to memory. */ |
| memcpy (target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, |
| writebuf_org + bp_addr - memaddr, bp_size); |
| |
| /* Determine appropriate breakpoint contents and size for this |
| address. */ |
| bp = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &placed_size); |
| |
| /* Update the final write buffer with this inserted |
| breakpoint's INSN. */ |
| memcpy (writebuf + bp_addr - memaddr, bp + bptoffset, bp_size); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR, |
| by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents. |
| |
| If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with any of |
| the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffers. Otherwise, |
| a failed assertion internal error will be raised. |
| |
| The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is: |
| bl->address - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max |
| up to bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max |
| The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is: |
| memaddr ... memaddr + len |
| Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are |
| memaddr + len <= (bl->address |
| - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max) |
| and: |
| bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */ |
| |
| void |
| breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf, |
| const gdb_byte *writebuf_org, |
| ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len) |
| { |
| /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary |
| search. */ |
| unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc; |
| |
| /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF |
| content. It is safe to report lower value but a failure to |
| report higher one. */ |
| |
| bc_l = 0; |
| bc_r = bp_locations.size (); |
| while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r) |
| { |
| struct bp_location *bl; |
| |
| bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2; |
| bl = bp_locations[bc]; |
| |
| /* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added |
| constant. Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure |
| the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR |
| to MEMADDR + LEN range). |
| |
| Use the BP_LOCATIONS_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety |
| offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow |
| range tail still reaching MEMADDR. */ |
| |
| if ((bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max |
| >= bl->address) |
| && (bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max |
| <= memaddr)) |
| bc_l = bc; |
| else |
| bc_r = bc; |
| } |
| |
| /* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the |
| first location that's at BC_L's address. E.g., if there are |
| multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing |
| at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted" |
| location. Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and |
| B: |
| |
| L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ... |
| |
| BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master" |
| location could be L1. Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set |
| on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1 |
| and L2. */ |
| while (bc_l > 0 |
| && bp_locations[bc_l]->address == bp_locations[bc_l - 1]->address) |
| bc_l--; |
| |
| /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */ |
| |
| for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_locations.size (); bc++) |
| { |
| struct bp_location *bl = bp_locations[bc]; |
| |
| /* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */ |
| if (bl->owner->type == bp_none) |
| warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"), |
| bl->owner->number); |
| |
| /* Performance optimization: any further element can no longer affect BUF |
| content. */ |
| |
| if (bl->address >= bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max |
| && (memaddr + len |
| <= (bl->address |
| - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max))) |
| break; |
| |
| if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl)) |
| continue; |
| |
| one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (readbuf, writebuf, writebuf_org, |
| memaddr, len, &bl->target_info, bl->gdbarch); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| bool |
| is_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt) |
| { |
| return (bpt->type == bp_breakpoint |
| || bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint |
| || bpt->type == bp_dprintf); |
| } |
| |
| /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */ |
| |
| static bool |
| is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt) |
| { |
| return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint |
| || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint |
| || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint); |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| bool |
| is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt) |
| { |
| return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt) |
| || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint); |
| } |
| |
| /* Returns true if the current thread and its running state are safe |
| to evaluate or update watchpoint B. Watchpoints on local |
| expressions need to be evaluated in the context of the thread that |
| was current when the watchpoint was created, and, that thread needs |
| to be stopped to be able to select the correct frame context. |
| Watchpoints on global expressions can be evaluated on any thread, |
| and in any state. It is presently left to the target allowing |
| memory accesses when threads are running. */ |
| |
| static int |
| watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct watchpoint *b) |
| { |
| return (b->pspace == current_program_space |
| && (b->watchpoint_thread == null_ptid |
| || (inferior_ptid == b->watchpoint_thread |
| && !inferior_thread ()->executing ()))); |
| } |
| |
| /* Set watchpoint B to disp_del_at_next_stop, even including its possible |
| associated bp_watchpoint_scope breakpoint. */ |
| |
| static void |
| watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (struct watchpoint *w) |
| { |
| if (w->related_breakpoint != w) |
| { |
| gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope); |
| gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == w); |
| w->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop; |
| w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w->related_breakpoint; |
| w->related_breakpoint = w; |
| } |
| w->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop; |
| } |
| |
| /* Extract a bitfield value from value VAL using the bit parameters contained in |
| watchpoint W. */ |
| |
| static struct value * |
| extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (struct watchpoint *w, struct value *val) |
| { |
| struct value *bit_val; |
| |
| if (val == NULL) |
| return NULL; |
| |
| bit_val = allocate_value (value_type (val)); |
| |
| unpack_value_bitfield (bit_val, |
| w->val_bitpos, |
| w->val_bitsize, |
| value_contents_for_printing (val).data (), |
| value_offset (val), |
| val); |
| |
| return bit_val; |
| } |
| |
| /* Allocate a dummy location and add it to B. This is required |
| because bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report |
| stops. */ |
| |
| static void |
| add_dummy_location (struct breakpoint *b, |
| struct program_space *pspace) |
| { |
| gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL); |
| |
| b->loc = new bp_location (b, bp_loc_other); |
| b->loc->pspace = pspace; |
| } |
| |
| /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint: |
| - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero |
| - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val |
| - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result |
| in b->loc->cond. |
| - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc. |
| |
| If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do |
| nothing. If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete |
| it. |
| |
| Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are |
| removed + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must |
| never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread |
| when debugging in non-stop mode. On the other hand, hardware |
| watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific |
| to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug |
| registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to |
| be able to modify its hardware watchpoints. |
| |
| Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being |
| presented to the user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would |
| reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user. And |
| it must not be done later because it could display the same single |
| watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops. Note that the latter is |
| relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint |
| and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is |
| not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has |
| not changed. |
| |
| The following constraints influence the location where we can reset |
| hardware watchpoints: |
| |
| * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are |
| called several times when GDB stops. |
| |
| [linux] |
| * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time, |
| causing GDB to stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint |
| hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits |
| are presented later, one after the other, each time the user |
| requests the execution to be resumed. Execution is not resumed |
| for the threads still having pending hit event stored in |
| LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from |
| the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being |
| reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address |
| until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets |
| presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset. |
| |
| Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the |
| watchpoint removal from inferior. */ |
| |
| static void |
| update_watchpoint (struct watchpoint *b, int reparse) |
| { |
| int within_current_scope; |
| struct frame_id saved_frame_id; |
| int frame_saved; |
| |
| /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the |
| watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread |
| that was used to create the watchpoint. */ |
| if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b)) |
| return; |
| |
| if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop) |
| return; |
| |
| frame_saved = 0; |
| |
| /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */ |
| if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL) |
| within_current_scope = 1; |
| else |
| { |
| struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame (); |
| struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (fi); |
| CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (fi); |
| |
| /* If we're at a point where the stack has been destroyed |
| (e.g. in a function epilogue), unwinding may not work |
| properly. Do not attempt to recreate locations at this |
| point. See similar comments in watchpoint_check. */ |
| if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc)) |
| return; |
| |
| /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after |
| evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */ |
| /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression |
| took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the |
| selected frame. */ |
| frame_saved = 1; |
| saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL)); |
| |
| fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame); |
| within_current_scope = (fi != NULL); |
| if (within_current_scope) |
| select_frame (fi); |
| } |
| |
| /* We don't free locations. They are stored in the bp_location array |
| and update_global_location_list will eventually delete them and |
| remove breakpoints if needed. */ |
| b->loc = NULL; |
| |
| if (within_current_scope && reparse) |
| { |
| const char *s; |
| |
| b->exp.reset (); |
| s = (b->exp_string_reparse |
| ? b->exp_string_reparse.get () |
| : b->exp_string.get ()); |
| b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->exp_valid_block, 0); |
| /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is |
| no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit |
| to the user when the old value and the new value may actually |
| be completely different objects. */ |
| b->val = NULL; |
| b->val_valid = false; |
| |
| /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition |
| expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the |
| locations (re)created below. */ |
| if (b->cond_string != NULL) |
| { |
| b->cond_exp.reset (); |
| |
| s = b->cond_string.get (); |
| b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because |
| it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library, |
| don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete |
| such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression |
| is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */ |
| if (!target_has_execution ()) |
| { |
| /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and |
| set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when |
| the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */ |
| if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints) |
| { |
| if (b->works_in_software_mode ()) |
| b->type = bp_watchpoint; |
| else |
| error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when " |
| "hardware watchpoints are disabled.")); |
| } |
| } |
| else if (within_current_scope && b->exp) |
| { |
| std::vector<value_ref_ptr> val_chain; |
| struct value *v, *result; |
| struct program_space *frame_pspace; |
| |
| fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), b->exp->op.get (), &v, &result, |
| &val_chain, false); |
| |
| /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of |
| b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update |
| it only if we reported that last value to user. As it |
| happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly. |
| We don't keep track of the memory value for masked |
| watchpoints. */ |
| if (!b->val_valid && !is_masked_watchpoint (b)) |
| { |
| if (b->val_bitsize != 0) |
| v = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, v); |
| b->val = release_value (v); |
| b->val_valid = true; |
| } |
| |
| frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL)); |
| |
| /* Look at each value on the value chain. */ |
| gdb_assert (!val_chain.empty ()); |
| for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : val_chain) |
| { |
| v = iter.get (); |
| |
| /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed |
| its contents to evaluate the expression, then we |
| must watch it. If the first value returned is |
| still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it; |
| watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */ |
| if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory |
| && (v == val_chain[0] || ! value_lazy (v))) |
| { |
| struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v)); |
| |
| /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked |
| for it explicitly, never if they just happen to |
| appear in the middle of some value chain. */ |
| if (v == result |
| || (vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT |
| && vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)) |
| { |
| CORE_ADDR addr; |
| enum target_hw_bp_type type; |
| struct bp_location *loc, **tmp; |
| int bitpos = 0, bitsize = 0; |
| |
| if (value_bitsize (v) != 0) |
| { |
| /* Extract the bit parameters out from the bitfield |
| sub-expression. */ |
| bitpos = value_bitpos (v); |
| bitsize = value_bitsize (v); |
| } |
| else if (v == result && b->val_bitsize != 0) |
| { |
| /* If VAL_BITSIZE != 0 then RESULT is actually a bitfield |
| lvalue whose bit parameters are saved in the fields |
| VAL_BITPOS and VAL_BITSIZE. */ |
| bitpos = b->val_bitpos; |
| bitsize = b->val_bitsize; |
| } |
| |
| addr = value_address (v); |
| if (bitsize != 0) |
| { |
| /* Skip the bytes that don't contain the bitfield. */ |
| addr += bitpos / 8; |
| } |
| |
| type = hw_write; |
| if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint) |
| type = hw_read; |
| else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint) |
| type = hw_access; |
| |
| loc = b->allocate_location (); |
| for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next)) |
| ; |
| *tmp = loc; |
| loc->gdbarch = value_type (v)->arch (); |
| |
| loc->pspace = frame_pspace; |
| loc->address = address_significant (loc->gdbarch, addr); |
| |
| if (bitsize != 0) |
| { |
| /* Just cover the bytes that make up the bitfield. */ |
| loc->length = ((bitpos % 8) + bitsize + 7) / 8; |
| } |
| else |
| loc->length = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v)); |
| |
| loc->watchpoint_type = type; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or |
| an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support |
| and free hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior |
| is started. */ |
| if (reparse) |
| { |
| int reg_cnt; |
| enum bp_loc_type loc_type; |
| |
| reg_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain); |
| |
| if (reg_cnt) |
| { |
| int i, target_resources_ok, other_type_used; |
| enum bptype type; |
| |
| /* Use an exact watchpoint when there's only one memory region to be |
| watched, and only one debug register is needed to watch it. */ |
| b->exact = target_exact_watchpoints && reg_cnt == 1; |
| |
| /* We need to determine how many resources are already |
| used for all other hardware watchpoints plus this one |
| to see if we still have enough resources to also fit |
| this watchpoint in as well. */ |
| |
| /* If this is a software watchpoint, we try to turn it |
| to a hardware one -- count resources as if B was of |
| hardware watchpoint type. */ |
| type = b->type; |
| if (type == bp_watchpoint) |
| type = bp_hardware_watchpoint; |
| |
| /* This watchpoint may or may not have been placed on |
| the list yet at this point (it won't be in the list |
| if we're trying to create it for the first time, |
| through watch_command), so always account for it |
| manually. */ |
| |
| /* Count resources used by all watchpoints except B. */ |
| i = hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (b, type, &other_type_used); |
| |
| /* Add in the resources needed for B. */ |
| i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b); |
| |
| target_resources_ok |
| = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (type, i, other_type_used); |
| if (target_resources_ok <= 0) |
| { |
| bool sw_mode = b->works_in_software_mode (); |
| |
| if (target_resources_ok == 0 && !sw_mode) |
| error (_("Target does not support this type of " |
| "hardware watchpoint.")); |
| else if (target_resources_ok < 0 && !sw_mode) |
| error (_("There are not enough available hardware " |
| "resources for this watchpoint.")); |
| |
| /* Downgrade to software watchpoint. */ |
| b->type = bp_watchpoint; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* If this was a software watchpoint, we've just |
| found we have enough resources to turn it to a |
| hardware watchpoint. Otherwise, this is a |
| nop. */ |
| b->type = type; |
| } |
| } |
| else if (!b->works_in_software_mode ()) |
| { |
| if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints) |
| error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when " |
| "hardware watchpoints are disabled.")); |
| else |
| error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with " |
| "read/access watchpoint.")); |
| } |
| else |
| b->type = bp_watchpoint; |
| |
| loc_type = (b->type == bp_watchpoint? bp_loc_software_watchpoint |
| : bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint); |
| for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ()) |
| bl->loc_type = loc_type; |
| } |
| |
| /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the |
| above left it without any location set up. But, |
| bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report |
| stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */ |
| if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL) |
| add_dummy_location (b, frame_pspace); |
| } |
| else if (!within_current_scope) |
| { |
| gdb_printf (_("\ |
| Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\ |
| in which its expression is valid.\n"), |
| b->number); |
| watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b); |
| } |
| |
| /* Restore the selected frame. */ |
| if (frame_saved) |
| select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id)); |
| } |
| |
| |
| /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be |
| inserted in the inferior. We don't differentiate the type of BL's owner |
| (breakpoint vs. tracepoint), although insert_location in tracepoint's |
| breakpoint_ops is not defined, because in insert_bp_location, |
| tracepoint's insert_location will not be called. */ |
| static int |
| should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl) |
| { |
| if (bl->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)) |
| return 0; |
| |
| if (bl->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop) |
| return 0; |
| |
| if (!bl->enabled || bl->disabled_by_cond |
| || bl->shlib_disabled || bl->duplicate) |
| return 0; |
| |
| if (user_breakpoint_p (bl->owner) && bl->pspace->executing_startup) |
| return 0; |
| |
| /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a |
| vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running |
| free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the |
| OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports |
| that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared |
| memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise |
| the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since |
| the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */ |
| if (bl->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed) |
| return 0; |
| |
| /* Don't insert a breakpoint if we're trying to step past its |
| location, except if the breakpoint is a single-step breakpoint, |
| and the breakpoint's thread is the thread which is stepping past |
| a breakpoint. */ |
| if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint |
| || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) |
| && stepping_past_instruction_at (bl->pspace->aspace, |
| bl->address) |
| /* The single-step breakpoint may be inserted at the location |
| we're trying to step if the instruction branches to itself. |
| However, the instruction won't be executed at all and it may |
| break the semantics of the instruction, for example, the |
| instruction is a conditional branch or updates some flags. |
| We can't fix it unless GDB is able to emulate the instruction |
| or switch to displaced stepping. */ |
| && !(bl->owner->type == bp_single_step |
| && thread_is_stepping_over_breakpoint (bl->owner->thread))) |
| { |
| infrun_debug_printf ("skipping breakpoint: stepping past insn at: %s", |
| paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address)); |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Don't insert watchpoints if we're trying to step past the |
| instruction that triggered one. */ |
| if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint) |
| && stepping_past_nonsteppable_watchpoint ()) |
| { |
| infrun_debug_printf ("stepping past non-steppable watchpoint. " |
| "skipping watchpoint at %s:%d", |
| paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address), bl->length); |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| /* Same as should_be_inserted but does the check assuming |
| that the location is not duplicated. */ |
| |
| static int |
| unduplicated_should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl) |
| { |
| int result; |
| const int save_duplicate = bl->duplicate; |
| |
| bl->duplicate = 0; |
| result = should_be_inserted (bl); |
| bl->duplicate = save_duplicate; |
| return result; |
| } |
| |
| /* Parses a conditional described by an expression COND into an |
| agent expression bytecode suitable for evaluation |
| by the bytecode interpreter. Return NULL if there was |
| any error during parsing. */ |
| |
| static agent_expr_up |
| parse_cond_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, struct expression *cond) |
| { |
| if (cond == NULL) |
| return NULL; |
| |
| agent_expr_up aexpr; |
| |
| /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors |
| that may show up. */ |
| try |
| { |
| aexpr = gen_eval_for_expr (scope, cond); |
| } |
| |
| catch (const gdb_exception_error &ex) |
| { |
| /* If we got here, it means the condition could not be parsed to a valid |
| bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side. |
| It's no use iterating through the conditions. */ |
| } |
| |
| /* We have a valid agent expression. */ |
| return aexpr; |
| } |
| |
| /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint conditions to be |
| passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with different |
| conditions, we will add such conditions to the list. The idea is that the |
| target will evaluate the list of conditions and will only notify GDB when |
| one of them is true. */ |
| |
| static void |
| build_target_condition_list (struct bp_location *bl) |
| { |
| int null_condition_or_parse_error = 0; |
| int modified = bl->needs_update; |
| |
| /* Release conditions left over from a previous insert. */ |
| bl->target_info.conditions.clear (); |
| |
| /* This is only meaningful if the target is |
| evaluating conditions and if the user has |
| opted for condition evaluation on the target's |
| side. */ |
| if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p () |
| || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) |
| return; |
| |
| auto loc_range = all_bp_locations_at_addr (bl->address); |
| |
| /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned |
| conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent |
| expression bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to |
| send conditions to the target since this location will always |
| trigger and generate a response back to GDB. Note we consider |
| all locations at the same address irrespective of type, i.e., |
| even if the locations aren't considered duplicates (e.g., |
| software breakpoint and hardware breakpoint at the same |
| address). */ |
| for (bp_location *loc : loc_range) |
| { |
| if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num) |
| { |
| if (modified) |
| { |
| /* Re-parse the conditions since something changed. In that |
| case we already freed the condition bytecodes (see |
| force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just |
| need to parse the condition to bytecodes again. */ |
| loc->cond_bytecode = parse_cond_to_aexpr (bl->address, |
| loc->cond.get ()); |
| } |
| |
| /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something |
| went wrong or we have a null condition expression. */ |
| if (!loc->cond_bytecode) |
| { |
| null_condition_or_parse_error = 1; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* If any of these happened, it means we will have to evaluate the conditions |
| for the location's address on gdb's side. It is no use keeping bytecodes |
| for all the other duplicate locations, thus we free all of them here. |
| |
| This is so we have a finer control over which locations' conditions are |
| being evaluated by GDB or the remote stub. */ |
| if (null_condition_or_parse_error) |
| { |
| for (bp_location *loc : loc_range) |
| { |
| if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num) |
| { |
| /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is |
| located. */ |
| if (!loc->cond_bytecode) |
| return; |
| |
| loc->cond_bytecode.reset (); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* No NULL conditions or failed bytecode generation. Build a |
| condition list for this location's address. If we have software |
| and hardware locations at the same address, they aren't |
| considered duplicates, but we still marge all the conditions |
| anyway, as it's simpler, and doesn't really make a practical |
| difference. */ |
| for (bp_location *loc : loc_range) |
| if (loc->cond |
| && is_breakpoint (loc->owner) |
| && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num |
| && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled |
| && loc->enabled |
| && !loc->disabled_by_cond) |
| { |
| /* Add the condition to the vector. This will be used later |
| to send the conditions to the target. */ |
| bl->target_info.conditions.push_back (loc->cond_bytecode.get ()); |
| } |
| |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| /* Parses a command described by string CMD into an agent expression |
| bytecode suitable for evaluation by the bytecode interpreter. |
| Return NULL if there was any error during parsing. */ |
| |
| static agent_expr_up |
| parse_cmd_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, char *cmd) |
| { |
| const char *cmdrest; |
| const char *format_start, *format_end; |
| struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch (); |
| |
| if (cmd == NULL) |
| return NULL; |
| |
| cmdrest = cmd; |
| |
| if (*cmdrest == ',') |
| ++cmdrest; |
| cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest); |
| |
| if (*cmdrest++ != '"') |
| error (_("No format string following the location")); |
| |
| format_start = cmdrest; |
| |
| format_pieces fpieces (&cmdrest); |
| |
| format_end = cmdrest; |
| |
| if (*cmdrest++ != '"') |
| error (_("Bad format string, non-terminated '\"'.")); |
| |
| cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest); |
| |
| if (!(*cmdrest == ',' || *cmdrest == '\0')) |
| error (_("Invalid argument syntax")); |
| |
| if (*cmdrest == ',') |
| cmdrest++; |
| cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest); |
| |
| /* For each argument, make an expression. */ |
| |
| std::vector<struct expression *> argvec; |
| while (*cmdrest != '\0') |
| { |
| const char *cmd1; |
| |
| cmd1 = cmdrest; |
| expression_up expr = parse_exp_1 (&cmd1, scope, block_for_pc (scope), 1); |
| argvec.push_back (expr.release ()); |
| cmdrest = cmd1; |
| if (*cmdrest == ',') |
| ++cmdrest; |
| } |
| |
| agent_expr_up aexpr; |
| |
| /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors |
| that may show up. */ |
| try |
| { |
| aexpr = gen_printf (scope, gdbarch, 0, 0, |
| format_start, format_end - format_start, |
| argvec.size (), argvec.data ()); |
| } |
| catch (const gdb_exception_error &ex) |
| { |
| /* If we got here, it means the command could not be parsed to a valid |
| bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side. |
| It's no use iterating through the other commands. */ |
| } |
| |
| /* We have a valid agent expression, return it. */ |
| return aexpr; |
| } |
| |
| /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint commands to be |
| passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with |
| different commands, we will add any such to the list. */ |
| |
| static void |
| build_target_command_list (struct bp_location *bl) |
| { |
| int null_command_or_parse_error = 0; |
| int modified = bl->needs_update; |
| |
| /* Clear commands left over from a previous insert. */ |
| bl->target_info.tcommands.clear (); |
| |
| if (!target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ()) |
| return; |
| |
| /* For now, limit to agent-style dprintf breakpoints. */ |
| if (dprintf_style != dprintf_style_agent) |
| return; |
| |
| auto loc_range = all_bp_locations_at_addr (bl->address); |
| |
| /* For now, if we have any location at the same address that isn't a |
| dprintf, don't install the target-side commands, as that would |
| make the breakpoint not be reported to the core, and we'd lose |
| control. */ |
| for (bp_location *loc : loc_range) |
| if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) |
| && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num |
| && loc->owner->type != bp_dprintf) |
| return; |
| |
| /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned |
| conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression |
| bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions |
| to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a |
| response back to GDB. */ |
| for (bp_location *loc : loc_range) |
| { |
| if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num) |
| { |
| if (modified) |
| { |
| /* Re-parse the commands since something changed. In that |
| case we already freed the command bytecodes (see |
| force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just |
| need to parse the command to bytecodes again. */ |
| loc->cmd_bytecode |
| = parse_cmd_to_aexpr (bl->address, |
| loc->owner->extra_string.get ()); |
| } |
| |
| /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something |
| went wrong or we have a null command expression. */ |
| if (!loc->cmd_bytecode) |
| { |
| null_command_or_parse_error = 1; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* If anything failed, then we're not doing target-side commands, |
| and so clean up. */ |
| if (null_command_or_parse_error) |
| { |
| for (bp_location *loc : loc_range) |
| if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) |
| && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num) |
| { |
| /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is |
| located. */ |
| if (loc->cmd_bytecode == NULL) |
| return; |
| |
| loc->cmd_bytecode.reset (); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* No NULL commands or failed bytecode generation. Build a command |
| list for all duplicate locations at this location's address. |
| Note that here we must care for whether the breakpoint location |
| types are considered duplicates, otherwise, say, if we have a |
| software and hardware location at the same address, the target |
| could end up running the commands twice. For the moment, we only |
| support targets-side commands with dprintf, but it doesn't hurt |
| to be pedantically correct in case that changes. */ |
| for (bp_location *loc : loc_range) |
| if (breakpoint_locations_match (bl, loc) |
| && loc->owner->extra_string |
| && is_breakpoint (loc->owner) |
| && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num |
| && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled |
| && loc->enabled |
| && !loc->disabled_by_cond) |
| { |
| /* Add the command to the vector. This will be used later |
| to send the commands to the target. */ |
| bl->target_info.tcommands.push_back (loc->cmd_bytecode.get ()); |
| } |
| |
| bl->target_info.persist = 0; |
| /* Maybe flag this location as persistent. */ |
| if (bl->owner->type == bp_dprintf && disconnected_dprintf) |
| bl->target_info.persist = 1; |
| } |
| |
| /* Return the kind of breakpoint on address *ADDR. Get the kind |
| of breakpoint according to ADDR except single-step breakpoint. |
| Get the kind of single-step breakpoint according to the current |
| registers state. */ |
| |
| static int |
| breakpoint_kind (struct bp_location *bl, CORE_ADDR *addr) |
| { |
| if (bl->owner->type == bp_single_step) |
| { |
| struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (bl->owner->thread); |
| struct regcache *regcache; |
| |
| regcache = get_thread_regcache (thr); |
| |
| return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_current_state (bl->gdbarch, |
| regcache, addr); |
| } |
| else |
| return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_pc (bl->gdbarch, addr); |
| } |
| |
| /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BL is the breakpoint |
| location. Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and |
| DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems. |
| Returns 0 for success, 1 if the bp_location type is not supported or |
| -1 for failure. |
| |
| NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an |
| object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */ |
| static int |
| insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl, |
| struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream, |
| int *disabled_breaks, |
| int *hw_breakpoint_error, |
| int *hw_bp_error_explained_already) |
| { |
| gdb_exception bp_excpt; |
| |
| if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update)) |
| return 0; |
| |
| /* Note we don't initialize bl->target_info, as that wipes out |
| the breakpoint location's shadow_contents if the breakpoint |
| is still inserted at that location. This in turn breaks |
| target_read_memory which depends on these buffers when |
| a memory read is requested at the breakpoint location: |
| Once the target_info has been wiped, we fail to see that |
| we have a breakpoint inserted at that address and thus |
| read the breakpoint instead of returning the data saved in |
| the breakpoint location's shadow contents. */ |
| bl->target_info.reqstd_address = bl->address; |
| bl->target_info.placed_address_space = bl->pspace->aspace; |
| bl->target_info.length = bl->length; |
| |
| /* When working with target-side conditions, we must pass all the conditions |
| for the same breakpoint address down to the target since GDB will not |
| insert those locations. With a list of breakpoint conditions, the target |
| can decide when to stop and notify GDB. */ |
| |
| if (is_breakpoint (bl->owner)) |
| { |
| build_target_condition_list (bl); |
| build_target_command_list (bl); |
| /* Reset the modification marker. */ |
| bl->needs_update = 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* If "set breakpoint auto-hw" is "on" and a software breakpoint was |
| set at a read-only address, then a breakpoint location will have |
| been changed to hardware breakpoint before we get here. If it is |
| "off" however, error out before actually trying to insert the |
| breakpoint, with a nicer error message. */ |
| if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint |
| && !automatic_hardware_breakpoints) |
| { |
| mem_region *mr = lookup_mem_region (bl->address); |
| |
| if (mr != nullptr && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW) |
| { |
| gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, |
| _("Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n" |
| "Cannot set software breakpoint " |
| "at read-only address %s\n"), |
| bl->owner->number, |
| paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address)); |
| return 1; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint |
| || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) |
| { |
| /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */ |
| if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off |
| || bl->section == NULL |
| || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section))) |
| { |
| /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */ |
| try |
| { |
| int val; |
| |
| val = bl->owner->insert_location (bl); |
| if (val) |
| bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR}; |
| } |
| catch (gdb_exception &e) |
| { |
| bp_excpt = std::move (e); |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section. |
| Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */ |
| if (!overlay_events_enabled) |
| { |
| /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, |
| so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA. |
| This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */ |
| if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) |
| warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"), |
| bl->owner->number); |
| else |
| { |
| CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bl->address, |
| bl->section); |
| /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */ |
| bl->overlay_target_info = bl->target_info; |
| bl->overlay_target_info.reqstd_address = addr; |
| |
| /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */ |
| try |
| { |
| int val; |
| |
| bl->overlay_target_info.kind |
| = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr); |
| bl->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr; |
| val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, |
| &bl->overlay_target_info); |
| if (val) |
| bp_excpt |
| = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR}; |
| } |
| catch (gdb_exception &e) |
| { |
| bp_excpt = std::move (e); |
| } |
| |
| if (bp_excpt.reason != 0) |
| gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, |
| "Overlay breakpoint %d " |
| "failed: in ROM?\n", |
| bl->owner->number); |
| } |
| } |
| /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */ |
| if (section_is_mapped (bl->section)) |
| { |
| /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */ |
| try |
| { |
| int val; |
| |
| val = bl->owner->insert_location (bl); |
| if (val) |
| bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR}; |
| } |
| catch (gdb_exception &e) |
| { |
| bp_excpt = std::move (e); |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted. |
| No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */ |
| return 0; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (bp_excpt.reason != 0) |
| { |
| /* Can't set the breakpoint. */ |
| |
| /* If the target has closed then it will have deleted any |
| breakpoints inserted within the target inferior, as a result |
| any further attempts to interact with the breakpoint objects |
| is not possible. Just rethrow the error. */ |
| if (bp_excpt.error == TARGET_CLOSE_ERROR) |
| throw bp_excpt; |
| gdb_assert (bl->owner != nullptr); |
| |
| /* In some cases, we might not be able to insert a |
| breakpoint in a shared library that has already been |
| removed, but we have not yet processed the shlib unload |
| event. Unfortunately, some targets that implement |
| breakpoint insertion themselves can't tell why the |
| breakpoint insertion failed (e.g., the remote target |
| doesn't define error codes), so we must treat generic |
| errors as memory errors. */ |
| if (bp_excpt.reason == RETURN_ERROR |
| && (bp_excpt.error == GENERIC_ERROR |
| || bp_excpt.error == MEMORY_ERROR) |
| && bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint |
| && (solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address) |
| || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace, |
| bl->address))) |
| { |
| /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */ |
| bl->shlib_disabled = 1; |
| gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bl->owner); |
| if (!*disabled_breaks) |
| { |
| gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, |
| "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n", |
| bl->owner->number); |
| gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, |
| "Temporarily disabling shared " |
| "library breakpoints:\n"); |
| } |
| *disabled_breaks = 1; |
| gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, |
| "breakpoint #%d\n", bl->owner->number); |
| return 0; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) |
| { |
| *hw_breakpoint_error = 1; |
| *hw_bp_error_explained_already = bp_excpt.message != NULL; |
| gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, |
| "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d%s", |
| bl->owner->number, |
| bp_excpt.message ? ":" : ".\n"); |
| if (bp_excpt.message != NULL) |
| gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, "%s.\n", |
| bp_excpt.what ()); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (bp_excpt.message == NULL) |
| { |
| std::string message |
| = memory_error_message (TARGET_XFER_E_IO, |
| bl->gdbarch, bl->address); |
| |
| gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, |
| "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n" |
| "%s\n", |
| bl->owner->number, message.c_str ()); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, |
| "Cannot insert breakpoint %d: %s\n", |
| bl->owner->number, |
| bp_excpt.what ()); |
| } |
| } |
| return 1; |
| |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| bl->inserted = 1; |
| |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint |
| /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing |
| watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */ |
| && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop) |
| { |
| int val; |
| |
| val = bl->owner->insert_location (bl); |
| |
| /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not |
| supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */ |
| if (val == 1 && bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read) |
| { |
| /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another |
| hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate |
| of this one. */ |
| for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ()) |
| if (loc != bl |
| && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access |
| && watchpoint_locations_match (bl, loc)) |
| { |
| bl->duplicate = 1; |
| bl->inserted = 1; |
| bl->target_info = loc->target_info; |
| bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access; |
| val = 0; |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| if (val == 1) |
| { |
| bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access; |
| val = bl->owner->insert_location (bl); |
| |
| if (val) |
| /* Back to the original value. */ |
| bl->watchpoint_type = hw_read; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| bl->inserted = (val == 0); |
| } |
| |
| else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint) |
| { |
| int val; |
| |
| val = bl->owner->insert_location (bl); |
| if (val) |
| { |
| bl->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled; |
| |
| if (val == 1) |
| warning (_("\ |
| Error inserting catchpoint %d: Your system does not support this type\n\ |
| of catchpoint."), bl->owner->number); |
| else |
| warning (_("Error inserting catchpoint %d."), bl->owner->number); |
| } |
| |
| bl->inserted = (val == 0); |
| |
| /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem |
| inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint, |
| so just return success. */ |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be |
| deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference |
| PSPACE anymore. */ |
| |
| void |
| breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace) |
| { |
| /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */ |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) |
| if (b->pspace == pspace) |
| delete_breakpoint (b); |
| |
| /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations |
| bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */ |
| for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ()) |
| { |
| struct bp_location *tmp; |
| |
| if (loc->pspace == pspace) |
| { |
| /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */ |
| if (loc->owner->loc == loc) |
| loc->owner->loc = loc->next; |
| else |
| for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next) |
| if (tmp->next == loc) |
| { |
| tmp->next = loc->next; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the |
| removed locations above. */ |
| update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); |
| } |
| |
| /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior. |
| Throws exception on any error. |
| A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted |
| again, so calling this function twice is safe. */ |
| void |
| insert_breakpoints (void) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *bpt : all_breakpoints ()) |
| if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)) |
| { |
| struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt; |
| |
| update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */); |
| } |
| |
| /* Updating watchpoints creates new locations, so update the global |
| location list. Explicitly tell ugll to insert locations and |
| ignore breakpoints_always_inserted_mode. Also, |
| update_global_location_list tries to "upgrade" software |
| breakpoints to hardware breakpoints to handle "set breakpoint |
| auto-hw", so we need to call it even if we don't have new |
| locations. */ |
| update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT); |
| } |
| |
| /* This is used when we need to synch breakpoint conditions between GDB and the |
| target. It is the case with deleting and disabling of breakpoints when using |
| always-inserted mode. */ |
| |
| static void |
| update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (void) |
| { |
| int error_flag = 0; |
| int val = 0; |
| int disabled_breaks = 0; |
| int hw_breakpoint_error = 0; |
| int hw_bp_details_reported = 0; |
| |
| string_file tmp_error_stream; |
| |
| /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if |
| there was an error. */ |
| tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n"); |
| |
| scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread; |
| |
| for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) |
| { |
| /* We only want to update software breakpoints and hardware |
| breakpoints. */ |
| if (!is_breakpoint (bl->owner)) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* We only want to update locations that are already inserted |
| and need updating. This is to avoid unwanted insertion during |
| deletion of breakpoints. */ |
| if (!bl->inserted || !bl->needs_update) |
| continue; |
| |
| switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace); |
| |
| /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need |
| to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even |
| if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still |
| insert breakpoints. */ |
| if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()) |
| && (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution ())) |
| continue; |
| |
| val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks, |
| &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_details_reported); |
| if (val) |
| error_flag = val; |
| } |
| |
| if (error_flag) |
| { |
| target_terminal::ours_for_output (); |
| error_stream (tmp_error_stream); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Used when starting or continuing the program. */ |
| |
| static void |
| insert_breakpoint_locations (void) |
| { |
| int error_flag = 0; |
| int val = 0; |
| int disabled_breaks = 0; |
| int hw_breakpoint_error = 0; |
| int hw_bp_error_explained_already = 0; |
| |
| string_file tmp_error_stream; |
| |
| /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if |
| there was an error. */ |
| tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n"); |
| |
| scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread; |
| |
| for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) |
| { |
| if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update)) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if |
| the thread no longer exists. ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location |
| has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */ |
| if (bl->owner->thread != -1 |
| && !valid_global_thread_id (bl->owner->thread)) |
| continue; |
| |
| switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace); |
| |
| /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need |
| to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even |
| if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still |
| insert breakpoints. */ |
| if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()) |
| && (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution ())) |
| continue; |
| |
| val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks, |
| &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_error_explained_already); |
| if (val) |
| error_flag = val; |
| } |
| |
| /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove |
| them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */ |
| for (breakpoint *bpt : all_breakpoints ()) |
| { |
| int some_failed = 0; |
| |
| if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt)) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop) |
| continue; |
| |
| for (bp_location *loc : bpt->locations ()) |
| if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc)) |
| { |
| some_failed = 1; |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| if (some_failed) |
| { |
| for (bp_location *loc : bpt->locations ()) |
| if (loc->inserted) |
| remove_breakpoint (loc); |
| |
| hw_breakpoint_error = 1; |
| tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert " |
| "hardware watchpoint %d.\n", |
| bpt->number); |
| error_flag = -1; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (error_flag) |
| { |
| /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a |
| message about possibly exhausted resources. */ |
| if (hw_breakpoint_error && !hw_bp_error_explained_already) |
| { |
| tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\ |
| You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n"); |
| } |
| target_terminal::ours_for_output (); |
| error_stream (tmp_error_stream); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Used when the program stops. |
| Returns zero if successful, or non-zero if there was a problem |
| removing a breakpoint location. */ |
| |
| int |
| remove_breakpoints (void) |
| { |
| int val = 0; |
| |
| for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) |
| if (bl->inserted && !is_tracepoint (bl->owner)) |
| val |= remove_breakpoint (bl); |
| |
| return val; |
| } |
| |
| /* When a thread exits, remove breakpoints that are related to |
| that thread. */ |
| |
| static void |
| remove_threaded_breakpoints (struct thread_info *tp, int silent) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) |
| { |
| if (b->thread == tp->global_num && user_breakpoint_p (b)) |
| { |
| b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop; |
| |
| gdb_printf (_("\ |
| Thread-specific breakpoint %d deleted - thread %s no longer in the thread list.\n"), |
| b->number, print_thread_id (tp)); |
| |
| /* Hide it from the user. */ |
| b->number = 0; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| void |
| remove_breakpoints_inf (inferior *inf) |
| { |
| int val; |
| |
| for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) |
| { |
| if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (bl->inserted && !bl->target_info.persist) |
| { |
| val = remove_breakpoint (bl); |
| if (val != 0) |
| return; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1; |
| |
| /* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL. |
| If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated |
| from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented. |
| Otherwise the breakpoint number will be populated from |
| breakpoint_count and that value incremented. Internal breakpoints |
| do not set the internal var bpnum. */ |
| static void |
| set_breakpoint_number (int internal, struct breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| if (internal) |
| b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--; |
| else |
| { |
| set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1); |
| b->number = breakpoint_count; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static struct breakpoint * |
| create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, |
| CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type) |
| { |
| std::unique_ptr<internal_breakpoint> b |
| (new internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, type, address)); |
| |
| b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--; |
| |
| return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b)); |
| } |
| |
| static const char *const longjmp_names[] = |
| { |
| "longjmp", "_longjmp", "siglongjmp", "_siglongjmp" |
| }; |
| #define NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES ARRAY_SIZE(longjmp_names) |
| |
| /* Per-objfile data private to breakpoint.c. */ |
| struct breakpoint_objfile_data |
| { |
| /* Minimal symbol for "_ovly_debug_event" (if any). */ |
| struct bound_minimal_symbol overlay_msym; |
| |
| /* Minimal symbol(s) for "longjmp", "siglongjmp", etc. (if any). */ |
| struct bound_minimal_symbol longjmp_msym[NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES]; |
| |
| /* True if we have looked for longjmp probes. */ |
| int longjmp_searched = 0; |
| |
| /* SystemTap probe points for longjmp (if any). These are non-owning |
| references. */ |
| std::vector<probe *> longjmp_probes; |
| |
| /* Minimal symbol for "std::terminate()" (if any). */ |
| struct bound_minimal_symbol terminate_msym; |
| |
| /* Minimal symbol for "_Unwind_DebugHook" (if any). */ |
| struct bound_minimal_symbol exception_msym; |
| |
| /* True if we have looked for exception probes. */ |
| int exception_searched = 0; |
| |
| /* SystemTap probe points for unwinding (if any). These are non-owning |
| references. */ |
| std::vector<probe *> exception_probes; |
| }; |
| |
| static const struct objfile_key<breakpoint_objfile_data> |
| breakpoint_objfile_key; |
| |
| /* Minimal symbol not found sentinel. */ |
| static struct minimal_symbol msym_not_found; |
| |
| /* Returns TRUE if MSYM point to the "not found" sentinel. */ |
| |
| static int |
| msym_not_found_p (const struct minimal_symbol *msym) |
| { |
| return msym == &msym_not_found; |
| } |
| |
| /* Return per-objfile data needed by breakpoint.c. |
| Allocate the data if necessary. */ |
| |
| static struct breakpoint_objfile_data * |
| get_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *objfile) |
| { |
| struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data; |
| |
| bp_objfile_data = breakpoint_objfile_key.get (objfile); |
| if (bp_objfile_data == NULL) |
| bp_objfile_data = breakpoint_objfile_key.emplace (objfile); |
| return bp_objfile_data; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| create_overlay_event_breakpoint (void) |
| { |
| const char *const func_name = "_ovly_debug_event"; |
| |
| for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ()) |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *b; |
| struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data; |
| CORE_ADDR addr; |
| struct explicit_location explicit_loc; |
| |
| bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile); |
| |
| if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym)) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym == NULL) |
| { |
| struct bound_minimal_symbol m; |
| |
| m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile); |
| if (m.minsym == NULL) |
| { |
| /* Avoid future lookups in this objfile. */ |
| bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found; |
| continue; |
| } |
| bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = m; |
| } |
| |
| addr = bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.value_address (); |
| b = create_internal_breakpoint (objfile->arch (), addr, |
| bp_overlay_event); |
| initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc); |
| explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name); |
| b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc); |
| |
| if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto) |
| { |
| b->enable_state = bp_enabled; |
| overlay_events_enabled = 1; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| b->enable_state = bp_disabled; |
| overlay_events_enabled = 0; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Install a master longjmp breakpoint for OBJFILE using a probe. Return |
| true if a breakpoint was installed. */ |
| |
| static bool |
| create_longjmp_master_breakpoint_probe (objfile *objfile) |
| { |
| struct gdbarch *gdbarch = objfile->arch (); |
| struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data |
| = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile); |
| |
| if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched) |
| { |
| std::vector<probe *> ret |
| = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libc", "longjmp"); |
| |
| if (!ret.empty ()) |
| { |
| /* We are only interested in checking one element. */ |
| probe *p = ret[0]; |
| |
| if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ()) |
| { |
| /* We cannot use the probe interface here, |
| because it does not know how to evaluate |
| arguments. */ |
| ret.clear (); |
| } |
| } |
| bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes = ret; |
| bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched = 1; |
| } |
| |
| if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes.empty ()) |
| return false; |
| |
| for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes) |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *b; |
| |
| b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, |
| p->get_relocated_address (objfile), |
| bp_longjmp_master); |
| b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libc:longjmp"); |
| b->enable_state = bp_disabled; |
| } |
| |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| /* Install master longjmp breakpoints for OBJFILE using longjmp_names. |
| Return true if at least one breakpoint was installed. */ |
| |
| static bool |
| create_longjmp_master_breakpoint_names (objfile *objfile) |
| { |
| struct gdbarch *gdbarch = objfile->arch (); |
| if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (gdbarch)) |
| return false; |
| |
| struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data |
| = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile); |
| unsigned int installed_bp = 0; |
| |
| for (int i = 0; i < NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES; i++) |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *b; |
| const char *func_name; |
| CORE_ADDR addr; |
| struct explicit_location explicit_loc; |
| |
| if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym)) |
| continue; |
| |
| func_name = longjmp_names[i]; |
| if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym == NULL) |
| { |
| struct bound_minimal_symbol m; |
| |
| m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile); |
| if (m.minsym == NULL) |
| { |
| /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */ |
| bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym = &msym_not_found; |
| continue; |
| } |
| bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = m; |
| } |
| |
| addr = bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].value_address (); |
| b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_longjmp_master); |
| initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc); |
| explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name); |
| b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc); |
| b->enable_state = bp_disabled; |
| installed_bp++; |
| } |
| |
| return installed_bp > 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Create a master longjmp breakpoint. */ |
| |
| static void |
| create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (void) |
| { |
| scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace; |
| |
| for (struct program_space *pspace : program_spaces) |
| { |
| set_current_program_space (pspace); |
| |
| for (objfile *obj : current_program_space->objfiles ()) |
| { |
| /* Skip separate debug object, it's handled in the loop below. */ |
| if (obj->separate_debug_objfile_backlink != nullptr) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* Try a probe kind breakpoint on main objfile. */ |
| if (create_longjmp_master_breakpoint_probe (obj)) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* Try longjmp_names kind breakpoints on main and separate_debug |
| objfiles. */ |
| for (objfile *debug_objfile : obj->separate_debug_objfiles ()) |
| if (create_longjmp_master_breakpoint_names (debug_objfile)) |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint. */ |
| static void |
| create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (void) |
| { |
| const char *const func_name = "std::terminate()"; |
| |
| scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace; |
| |
| for (struct program_space *pspace : program_spaces) |
| { |
| CORE_ADDR addr; |
| |
| set_current_program_space (pspace); |
| |
| for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ()) |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *b; |
| struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data; |
| struct explicit_location explicit_loc; |
| |
| bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile); |
| |
| if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym)) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym == NULL) |
| { |
| struct bound_minimal_symbol m; |
| |
| m = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile); |
| if (m.minsym == NULL || (m.minsym->type () != mst_text |
| && m.minsym->type () != mst_file_text)) |
| { |
| /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */ |
| bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found; |
| continue; |
| } |
| bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = m; |
| } |
| |
| addr = bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.value_address (); |
| b = create_internal_breakpoint (objfile->arch (), addr, |
| bp_std_terminate_master); |
| initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc); |
| explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name); |
| b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc); |
| b->enable_state = bp_disabled; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook for OBJFILE using a |
| probe. Return true if a breakpoint was installed. */ |
| |
| static bool |
| create_exception_master_breakpoint_probe (objfile *objfile) |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *b; |
| struct gdbarch *gdbarch; |
| struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data; |
| |
| bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile); |
| |
| /* We prefer the SystemTap probe point if it exists. */ |
| if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_searched) |
| { |
| std::vector<probe *> ret |
| = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libgcc", "unwind"); |
| |
| if (!ret.empty ()) |
| { |
| /* We are only interested in checking one element. */ |
| probe *p = ret[0]; |
| |
| if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ()) |
| { |
| /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does |
| not know how to evaluate arguments. */ |
| ret.clear (); |
| } |
| } |
| bp_objfile_data->exception_probes = ret; |
| bp_objfile_data->exception_searched = 1; |
| } |
| |
| if (bp_objfile_data->exception_probes.empty ()) |
| return false; |
| |
| gdbarch = objfile->arch (); |
| |
| for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->exception_probes) |
| { |
| b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, |
| p->get_relocated_address (objfile), |
| bp_exception_master); |
| b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libgcc:unwind"); |
| b->enable_state = bp_disabled; |
| } |
| |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook for OBJFILE using |
| _Unwind_DebugHook. Return true if a breakpoint was installed. */ |
| |
| static bool |
| create_exception_master_breakpoint_hook (objfile *objfile) |
| { |
| const char *const func_name = "_Unwind_DebugHook"; |
| struct breakpoint *b; |
| struct gdbarch *gdbarch; |
| struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data; |
| CORE_ADDR addr; |
| struct explicit_location explicit_loc; |
| |
| bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile); |
| |
| if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym)) |
| return false; |
| |
| gdbarch = objfile->arch (); |
| |
| if (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym == NULL) |
| { |
| struct bound_minimal_symbol debug_hook; |
| |
| debug_hook = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile); |
| if (debug_hook.minsym == NULL) |
| { |
| bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found; |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = debug_hook; |
| } |
| |
| addr = bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.value_address (); |
| addr = gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr |
| (gdbarch, addr, current_inferior ()->top_target ()); |
| b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_exception_master); |
| initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc); |
| explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name); |
| b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc); |
| b->enable_state = bp_disabled; |
| |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook. */ |
| |
| static void |
| create_exception_master_breakpoint (void) |
| { |
| for (objfile *obj : current_program_space->objfiles ()) |
| { |
| /* Skip separate debug object. */ |
| if (obj->separate_debug_objfile_backlink) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* Try a probe kind breakpoint. */ |
| if (create_exception_master_breakpoint_probe (obj)) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* Iterate over main and separate debug objects and try an |
| _Unwind_DebugHook kind breakpoint. */ |
| for (objfile *debug_objfile : obj->separate_debug_objfiles ()) |
| if (create_exception_master_breakpoint_hook (debug_objfile)) |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Does B have a location spec? */ |
| |
| static int |
| breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (const struct breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| return b->location != NULL && event_location_empty_p (b->location.get ()); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| update_breakpoints_after_exec (void) |
| { |
| /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the |
| INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by |
| writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The |
| "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not |
| do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking |
| breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that |
| here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete |
| breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */ |
| for (bp_location *bploc : all_bp_locations ()) |
| if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space) |
| gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted); |
| |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) |
| { |
| if (b->pspace != current_program_space) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */ |
| if (b->type == bp_shlib_event) |
| { |
| delete_breakpoint (b); |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */ |
| if (b->type == bp_jit_event) |
| { |
| delete_breakpoint (b); |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(), |
| as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */ |
| if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event |
| || b->type == bp_longjmp_master || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master |
| || b->type == bp_exception_master) |
| { |
| delete_breakpoint (b); |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */ |
| if (b->type == bp_step_resume || b->type == bp_hp_step_resume) |
| { |
| delete_breakpoint (b); |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| /* Just like single-step breakpoints. */ |
| if (b->type == bp_single_step) |
| { |
| delete_breakpoint (b); |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless |
| after an exec. */ |
| if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume |
| || b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy |
| || b->type == bp_exception || b->type == bp_exception_resume) |
| { |
| delete_breakpoint (b); |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| if (b->type == bp_catchpoint) |
| { |
| /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to |
| do anything at this point. In the future, if some of |
| the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add |
| a new method, and call this method from here. */ |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able |
| to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user |
| caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just |
| carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting |
| a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish |
| will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec. |
| |
| We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But |
| we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to |
| the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a |
| chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish |
| here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command |
| gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint. |
| We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish. |
| |
| In the absence of a general solution for the "how do we know |
| it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?" |
| problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and |
| let finish_command delete it. |
| |
| (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's |
| momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees |
| the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's |
| address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the |
| solib breakpoints.) */ |
| |
| if (b->type == bp_finish) |
| { |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the |
| pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec() |
| a.out. */ |
| if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b)) |
| { |
| delete_breakpoint (b); |
| continue; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| int |
| detach_breakpoints (ptid_t ptid) |
| { |
| int val = 0; |
| scoped_restore save_inferior_ptid = make_scoped_restore (&inferior_ptid); |
| struct inferior *inf = current_inferior (); |
| |
| if (ptid.pid () == inferior_ptid.pid ()) |
| error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid")); |
| |
| /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */ |
| inferior_ptid = ptid; |
| for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) |
| { |
| if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* This function must physically remove breakpoints locations |
| from the specified ptid, without modifying the breakpoint |
| package's state. Locations of type bp_loc_other and |
| bp_loc_software_watchpoint are only maintained at GDB side, |
| so there is no need to remove them. Moreover, removing these |
| would modify the breakpoint package's state. */ |
| if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_other |
| || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_watchpoint) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (bl->inserted) |
| val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, DETACH_BREAKPOINT); |
| } |
| |
| return val; |
| } |
| |
| /* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space. |
| Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork. |
| When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither |
| do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should |
| *not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here. */ |
| |
| static int |
| remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason) |
| { |
| int val; |
| |
| /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */ |
| gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL); |
| |
| /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted. |
| This should not ever happen. */ |
| gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none); |
| |
| if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint |
| || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) |
| { |
| /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard |
| trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a |
| bp_hardware_breakpoint. */ |
| |
| /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */ |
| if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off |
| || bl->section == NULL |
| || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section))) |
| { |
| /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */ |
| |
| /* If we're trying to uninsert a memory breakpoint that we |
| know is set in a dynamic object that is marked |
| shlib_disabled, then either the dynamic object was |
| removed with "remove-symbol-file" or with |
| "nosharedlibrary". In the former case, we don't know |
| whether another dynamic object might have loaded over the |
| breakpoint's address -- the user might well let us know |
| about it next with add-symbol-file (the whole point of |
| add-symbol-file is letting the user manually maintain a |
| list of dynamically loaded objects). If we have the |
| breakpoint's shadow memory, that is, this is a software |
| breakpoint managed by GDB, check whether the breakpoint |
| is still inserted in memory, to avoid overwriting wrong |
| code with stale saved shadow contents. Note that HW |
| breakpoints don't have shadow memory, as they're |
| implemented using a mechanism that is not dependent on |
| being able to modify the target's memory, and as such |
| they should always be removed. */ |
| if (bl->shlib_disabled |
| && bl->target_info.shadow_len != 0 |
| && !memory_validate_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info)) |
| val = 0; |
| else |
| val = bl->owner->remove_location (bl, reason); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section. |
| Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */ |
| if (!overlay_events_enabled) |
| { |
| /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we |
| should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it. |
| */ |
| /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will |
| have already warned when we failed to insert it. */ |
| if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) |
| target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, |
| &bl->overlay_target_info); |
| else |
| target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, |
| &bl->overlay_target_info, |
| reason); |
| } |
| /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA? |
| If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */ |
| if (bl->inserted) |
| { |
| /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to |
| remove the breakpoint if the section had been |
| unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We |
| don't know what the overlay manager might do. */ |
| |
| /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only |
| if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite |
| wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */ |
| if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint |
| || section_is_mapped (bl->section)) |
| val = bl->owner->remove_location (bl, reason); |
| else |
| val = 0; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */ |
| val = 0; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint in |
| a shared library that has already been removed, but we have |
| not yet processed the shlib unload event. Similarly for an |
| unloaded add-symbol-file object - the user might not yet have |
| had the chance to remove-symbol-file it. shlib_disabled will |
| be set if the library/object has already been removed, but |
| the breakpoint hasn't been uninserted yet, e.g., after |
| "nosharedlibrary" or "remove-symbol-file" with breakpoints |
| always-inserted mode. */ |
| if (val |
| && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint |
| && (bl->shlib_disabled |
| || solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address) |
| || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace, |
| bl->address)))) |
| val = 0; |
| |
| if (val) |
| return val; |
| bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT); |
| } |
| else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint) |
| { |
| bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT); |
| bl->owner->remove_location (bl, reason); |
| |
| /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */ |
| if (reason == REMOVE_BREAKPOINT && bl->inserted) |
| warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."), |
| bl->owner->number); |
| } |
| else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint |
| && breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner) |
| && !bl->duplicate) |
| { |
| val = bl->owner->remove_location (bl, reason); |
| if (val) |
| return val; |
| |
| bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT); |
| } |
| |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| static int |
| remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *bl) |
| { |
| /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */ |
| gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL); |
| |
| /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted. |
| This should not ever happen. */ |
| gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none); |
| |
| scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread; |
| |
| switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace); |
| |
| return remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, REMOVE_BREAKPOINT); |
| } |
| |
| /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */ |
| |
| void |
| mark_breakpoints_out (void) |
| { |
| for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) |
| if (bl->pspace == current_program_space) |
| bl->inserted = 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any |
| breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program. |
| |
| Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints |
| between runs. |
| |
| Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by |
| generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by |
| init_wait_for_inferior). */ |
| |
| |
| |
| void |
| breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context) |
| { |
| struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space; |
| |
| /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's |
| nothing to do. */ |
| if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())) |
| return; |
| |
| mark_breakpoints_out (); |
| |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) |
| { |
| if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace) |
| continue; |
| |
| switch (b->type) |
| { |
| case bp_call_dummy: |
| case bp_longjmp_call_dummy: |
| |
| /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will |
| cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get |
| rid of it. */ |
| |
| case bp_watchpoint_scope: |
| |
| /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */ |
| |
| case bp_shlib_event: |
| |
| /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may |
| have changed since the last time we ran the program. |
| Actually we may now be debugging against different target; |
| and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may |
| not be used in by the target. E.g., |
| |
| (gdb) file prog-linux |
| (gdb) run # native linux target |
| ... |
| (gdb) kill |
| (gdb) file prog-win.exe |
| (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver. |
| */ |
| |
| case bp_step_resume: |
| |
| /* Also remove step-resume breakpoints. */ |
| |
| case bp_single_step: |
| |
| /* Also remove single-step breakpoints. */ |
| |
| delete_breakpoint (b); |
| break; |
| |
| case bp_watchpoint: |
| case bp_hardware_watchpoint: |
| case bp_read_watchpoint: |
| case bp_access_watchpoint: |
| { |
| struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b; |
| |
| /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */ |
| if (w->exp_valid_block != NULL) |
| delete_breakpoint (b); |
| else |
| { |
| /* Get rid of existing locations, which are no longer |
| valid. New ones will be created in |
| update_watchpoint, when the inferior is restarted. |
| The next update_global_location_list call will |
| garbage collect them. */ |
| b->loc = NULL; |
| |
| if (context == inf_starting) |
| { |
| /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in |
| insert_breakpoints. */ |
| w->val.reset (nullptr); |
| w->val_valid = false; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| break; |
| default: |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */ |
| for (bp_location *bl : moribund_locations) |
| decref_bp_location (&bl); |
| moribund_locations.clear (); |
| } |
| |
| /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the |
| target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if |
| we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space |
| match, not program space. */ |
| |
| /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint |
| exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an |
| ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a |
| permanent breakpoint. |
| - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we |
| actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints. |
| - When continuing from a location with a permanent breakpoint, we |
| need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by |
| the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */ |
| |
| enum breakpoint_here |
| breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc) |
| { |
| int any_breakpoint_here = 0; |
| |
| for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) |
| { |
| if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint |
| && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */ |
| if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner) |
| || bl->permanent) |
| && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc)) |
| { |
| if (overlay_debugging |
| && section_is_overlay (bl->section) |
| && !section_is_mapped (bl->section)) |
| continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */ |
| else if (bl->permanent) |
| return permanent_breakpoint_here; |
| else |
| any_breakpoint_here = 1; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : no_breakpoint_here; |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| int |
| breakpoint_in_range_p (const address_space *aspace, |
| CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len) |
| { |
| for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) |
| { |
| if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint |
| && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) |
| continue; |
| |
| if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner) |
| || bl->permanent) |
| && breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (bl, aspace, |
| addr, len)) |
| { |
| if (overlay_debugging |
| && section_is_overlay (bl->section) |
| && !section_is_mapped (bl->section)) |
| { |
| /* Unmapped overlay -- can't be a match. */ |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| return 1; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */ |
| |
| int |
| moribund_breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc) |
| { |
| for (bp_location *loc : moribund_locations) |
| if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc)) |
| return 1; |
| |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Returns non-zero iff BL is inserted at PC, in address space |
| ASPACE. */ |
| |
| static int |
| bp_location_inserted_here_p (struct bp_location *bl, |
| const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc) |
| { |
| if (bl->inserted |
| && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address, |
| aspace, pc)) |
| { |
| if (overlay_debugging |
| && section_is_overlay (bl->section) |
| && !section_is_mapped (bl->section)) |
| return 0; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */ |
| else |
| return 1; |
| } |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Returns non-zero iff there's a breakpoint inserted at PC. */ |
| |
| int |
| breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc) |
| { |
| for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations_at_addr (pc)) |
| { |
| if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint |
| && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc)) |
| return 1; |
| } |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint |
| inserted at PC. */ |
| |
| int |
| software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace, |
| CORE_ADDR pc) |
| { |
| for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations_at_addr (pc)) |
| { |
| if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc)) |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| int |
| hardware_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace, |
| CORE_ADDR pc) |
| { |
| for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations_at_addr (pc)) |
| { |
| if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc)) |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| int |
| hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (const address_space *aspace, |
| CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *bpt : all_breakpoints ()) |
| { |
| if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint |
| && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt)) |
| continue; |
| |
| for (bp_location *loc : bpt->locations ()) |
| if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted) |
| { |
| CORE_ADDR l, h; |
| |
| /* Check for intersection. */ |
| l = std::max<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address, addr); |
| h = std::min<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len); |
| if (l < h) |
| return 1; |
| } |
| } |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| bool |
| is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| return (b->type == bp_catchpoint); |
| } |
| |
| /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint. |
| Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */ |
| |
| void |
| bpstat_clear (bpstat **bsp) |
| { |
| bpstat *p; |
| bpstat *q; |
| |
| if (bsp == 0) |
| return; |
| p = *bsp; |
| while (p != NULL) |
| { |
| q = p->next; |
| delete p; |
| p = q; |
| } |
| *bsp = NULL; |
| } |
| |
| bpstat::bpstat (const bpstat &other) |
| : next (NULL), |
| bp_location_at (other.bp_location_at), |
| breakpoint_at (other.breakpoint_at), |
| commands (other.commands), |
| print (other.print), |
| stop (other.stop), |
| print_it (other.print_it) |
| { |
| if (other.old_val != NULL) |
| old_val = release_value (value_copy (other.old_val.get ())); |
| } |
| |
| /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that |
| is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */ |
| |
| bpstat * |
| bpstat_copy (bpstat *bs) |
| { |
| bpstat *p = nullptr; |
| bpstat *tmp; |
| bpstat *retval = nullptr; |
| |
| if (bs == NULL) |
| return bs; |
| |
| for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) |
| { |
| tmp = new bpstat (*bs); |
| |
| if (p == NULL) |
| /* This is the first thing in the chain. */ |
| retval = tmp; |
| else |
| p->next = tmp; |
| p = tmp; |
| } |
| p->next = NULL; |
| return retval; |
| } |
| |
| /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint. */ |
| |
| bpstat * |
| bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat *bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint) |
| { |
| if (bsp == NULL) |
| return NULL; |
| |
| for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next) |
| { |
| if (bsp->breakpoint_at == breakpoint) |
| return bsp; |
| } |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| bool |
| bpstat_explains_signal (bpstat *bsp, enum gdb_signal sig) |
| { |
| for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next) |
| { |
| if (bsp->breakpoint_at == NULL) |
| { |
| /* A moribund location can never explain a signal other than |
| GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */ |
| if (sig == GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP) |
| return true; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (bsp->breakpoint_at->explains_signal (sig)) |
| return true; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are |
| stopped at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the |
| remaining breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be |
| good for anything but further calls to bpstat_num). |
| |
| Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints. |
| Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since |
| we set it. |
| Return 1 otherwise. */ |
| |
| int |
| bpstat_num (bpstat **bsp, int *num) |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *b; |
| |
| if ((*bsp) == NULL) |
| return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */ |
| |
| /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a |
| single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the |
| same number more than once and this will look ugly. */ |
| b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at; |
| *bsp = (*bsp)->next; |
| if (b == NULL) |
| return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */ |
| |
| *num = b->number; /* We have its number */ |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| void |
| bpstat_clear_actions (void) |
| { |
| bpstat *bs; |
| |
| if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid) |
| return; |
| |
| thread_info *tp = inferior_thread (); |
| for (bs = tp->control.stop_bpstat; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) |
| { |
| bs->commands = NULL; |
| bs->old_val.reset (nullptr); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */ |
| |
| static void |
| breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void) |
| { |
| if (inferior_ptid != null_ptid) |
| { |
| struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread (); |
| |
| /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not |
| interrupt the command list. When the call finishes |
| successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same |
| breakpoint as if nothing happened. */ |
| if (tp->control.in_infcall) |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| breakpoint_proceeded = 1; |
| } |
| |
| /* Return non-zero iff CMD as the first line of a command sequence is `silent' |
| or its equivalent. */ |
| |
| static int |
| command_line_is_silent (struct command_line *cmd) |
| { |
| return cmd && (strcmp ("silent", cmd->line) == 0); |
| } |
| |
| /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at |
| this location. Any of these commands could cause the process to |
| proceed beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by |
| checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command. |
| |
| Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that |
| case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the |
| bpstat of the current thread. */ |
| |
| static int |
| bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat **bsp) |
| { |
| bpstat *bs; |
| int again = 0; |
| |
| /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained |
| in bs->commands. */ |
| if (executing_breakpoint_commands) |
| return 0; |
| |
| scoped_restore save_executing |
| = make_scoped_restore (&executing_breakpoint_commands, 1); |
| |
| scoped_restore preventer = prevent_dont_repeat (); |
| |
| /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */ |
| bs = *bsp; |
| |
| breakpoint_proceeded = 0; |
| for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) |
| { |
| struct command_line *cmd = NULL; |
| |
| /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one. |
| |
| The command tree could legitimately contain commands like |
| 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which |
| frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't |
| free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to |
| take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's |
| commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we |
| can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free |
| the tree when we're done. */ |
| counted_command_line ccmd = bs->commands; |
| bs->commands = NULL; |
| if (ccmd != NULL) |
| cmd = ccmd.get (); |
| if (command_line_is_silent (cmd)) |
| { |
| /* The action has been already done by bpstat_stop_status. */ |
| cmd = cmd->next; |
| } |
| |
| while (cmd != NULL) |
| { |
| execute_control_command (cmd); |
| |
| if (breakpoint_proceeded) |
| break; |
| else |
| cmd = cmd->next; |
| } |
| |
| if (breakpoint_proceeded) |
| { |
| if (current_ui->async) |
| /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still |
| running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for |
| us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */ |
| ; |
| else |
| /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns |
| we're already standing on the next breakpoint. |
| Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since |
| execute_command does not run breakpoint commands -- |
| only command_line_handler does, but that one is not |
| involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we |
| can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be |
| noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is |
| not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive |
| invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a |
| command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we |
| return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us |
| with the new stop_bpstat. */ |
| again = 1; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| return again; |
| } |
| |
| /* Helper for bpstat_do_actions. Get the current thread, if there's |
| one, is alive and has execution. Return NULL otherwise. */ |
| |
| static thread_info * |
| get_bpstat_thread () |
| { |
| if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution ()) |
| return NULL; |
| |
| thread_info *tp = inferior_thread (); |
| if (tp->state == THREAD_EXITED || tp->executing ()) |
| return NULL; |
| return tp; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| bpstat_do_actions (void) |
| { |
| auto cleanup_if_error = make_scope_exit (bpstat_clear_actions); |
| thread_info *tp; |
| |
| /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */ |
| while ((tp = get_bpstat_thread ()) != NULL) |
| { |
| /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the |
| inferior, and only return when it is stopped at the next |
| breakpoint, we keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns |
| false to indicate the inferior was not resumed. */ |
| if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tp->control.stop_bpstat)) |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| cleanup_if_error.release (); |
| } |
| |
| /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */ |
| |
| static void |
| watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream) |
| { |
| if (val == NULL) |
| fprintf_styled (stream, metadata_style.style (), _("<unreadable>")); |
| else |
| { |
| struct value_print_options opts; |
| get_user_print_options (&opts); |
| value_print (val, stream, &opts); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Print the "Thread ID hit" part of "Thread ID hit Breakpoint N" if |
| debugging multiple threads. */ |
| |
| void |
| maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (struct ui_out *uiout) |
| { |
| if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) |
| return; |
| |
| uiout->text ("\n"); |
| |
| if (show_thread_that_caused_stop ()) |
| { |
| struct thread_info *thr = inferior_thread (); |
| |
| uiout->text ("Thread "); |
| uiout->field_string ("thread-id", print_thread_id (thr)); |
| |
| const char *name = thread_name (thr); |
| if (name != NULL) |
| { |
| uiout->text (" \""); |
| uiout->field_string ("name", name); |
| uiout->text ("\""); |
| } |
| |
| uiout->text (" hit "); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we |
| stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value |
| 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we |
| may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to |
| normal_stop(). */ |
| |
| static enum print_stop_action |
| print_bp_stop_message (bpstat *bs) |
| { |
| switch (bs->print_it) |
| { |
| case print_it_noop: |
| /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */ |
| return PRINT_UNKNOWN; |
| break; |
| |
| case print_it_done: |
| /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the |
| relevant messages. */ |
| return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC; |
| break; |
| |
| case print_it_normal: |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at; |
| |
| /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint |
| which has since been deleted. */ |
| if (b == NULL) |
| return PRINT_UNKNOWN; |
| |
| /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method. */ |
| return b->print_it (bs); |
| } |
| break; |
| |
| default: |
| internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, |
| _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value")); |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| void |
| print_solib_event (bool is_catchpoint) |
| { |
| bool any_deleted = !current_program_space->deleted_solibs.empty (); |
| bool any_added = !current_program_space->added_solibs.empty (); |
| |
| if (!is_catchpoint) |
| { |
| if (any_added || any_deleted) |
| current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event:\n")); |
| else |
| current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event (no " |
| "libraries added or removed)\n")); |
| } |
| |
| if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) |
| current_uiout->field_string ("reason", |
| async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_SOLIB_EVENT)); |
| |
| if (any_deleted) |
| { |
| current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior unloaded ")); |
| ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "removed"); |
| for (int ix = 0; ix < current_program_space->deleted_solibs.size (); ix++) |
| { |
| const std::string &name = current_program_space->deleted_solibs[ix]; |
| |
| if (ix > 0) |
| current_uiout->text (" "); |
| current_uiout->field_string ("library", name); |
| current_uiout->text ("\n"); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (any_added) |
| { |
| current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior loaded ")); |
| ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "added"); |
| bool first = true; |
| for (so_list *iter : current_program_space->added_solibs) |
| { |
| if (!first) |
| current_uiout->text (" "); |
| first = false; |
| current_uiout->field_string ("library", iter->so_name); |
| current_uiout->text ("\n"); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from |
| normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat |
| list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. KIND is |
| the target_waitkind for the stopping event. This |
| routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message |
| about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the |
| "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this |
| routine is one of: |
| |
| PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing. |
| PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent |
| code to print the location. An example is |
| "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by |
| the location. |
| PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need |
| to also print the location part of the message. |
| An example is the catch/throw messages, which |
| don't require a location appended to the end. |
| PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any |
| further info to be printed. */ |
| |
| enum print_stop_action |
| bpstat_print (bpstat *bs, int kind) |
| { |
| enum print_stop_action val; |
| |
| /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop. |
| (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not. |
| That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken |
| with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */ |
| for (; bs; bs = bs->next) |
| { |
| val = print_bp_stop_message (bs); |
| if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY |
| || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC |
| || val == PRINT_NOTHING) |
| return val; |
| } |
| |
| /* If we had hit a shared library event breakpoint, |
| print_bp_stop_message would print out this message. If we hit an |
| OS-level shared library event, do the same thing. */ |
| if (kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED) |
| { |
| print_solib_event (false); |
| return PRINT_NOTHING; |
| } |
| |
| /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start |
| with and nothing was printed. */ |
| return PRINT_UNKNOWN; |
| } |
| |
| /* Evaluate the boolean expression EXP and return the result. */ |
| |
| static bool |
| breakpoint_cond_eval (expression *exp) |
| { |
| struct value *mark = value_mark (); |
| bool res = value_true (evaluate_expression (exp)); |
| |
| value_free_to_mark (mark); |
| return res; |
| } |
| |
| /* Allocate a new bpstat. Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER. */ |
| |
| bpstat::bpstat (struct bp_location *bl, bpstat ***bs_link_pointer) |
| : next (NULL), |
| bp_location_at (bp_location_ref_ptr::new_reference (bl)), |
| breakpoint_at (bl->owner), |
| commands (NULL), |
| print (0), |
| stop (0), |
| print_it (print_it_normal) |
| { |
| **bs_link_pointer = this; |
| *bs_link_pointer = &next; |
| } |
| |
| bpstat::bpstat () |
| : next (NULL), |
| breakpoint_at (NULL), |
| commands (NULL), |
| print (0), |
| stop (0), |
| print_it (print_it_normal) |
| { |
| } |
| |
| /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware |
| watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */ |
| |
| int |
| watchpoints_triggered (const target_waitstatus &ws) |
| { |
| bool stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint (); |
| CORE_ADDR addr; |
| |
| if (!stopped_by_watchpoint) |
| { |
| /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints |
| as not triggered. */ |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)) |
| { |
| struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b; |
| |
| w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no; |
| } |
| |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| if (!target_stopped_data_address (current_inferior ()->top_target (), &addr)) |
| { |
| /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where. |
| Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */ |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)) |
| { |
| struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b; |
| |
| w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown; |
| } |
| |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints |
| affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not |
| triggered. */ |
| |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)) |
| { |
| struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b; |
| |
| w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no; |
| for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ()) |
| { |
| if (is_masked_watchpoint (b)) |
| { |
| CORE_ADDR newaddr = addr & w->hw_wp_mask; |
| CORE_ADDR start = loc->address & w->hw_wp_mask; |
| |
| if (newaddr == start) |
| { |
| w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| /* Exact match not required. Within range is sufficient. */ |
| else if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range |
| (current_inferior ()->top_target (), addr, loc->address, |
| loc->length)) |
| { |
| w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check. */ |
| enum wp_check_result |
| { |
| /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */ |
| WP_DELETED = 1, |
| |
| /* The value has changed. */ |
| WP_VALUE_CHANGED = 2, |
| |
| /* The value has not changed. */ |
| WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED = 3, |
| |
| /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */ |
| WP_IGNORE = 4, |
| }; |
| |
| #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1 |
| #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2 |
| |
| /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value |
| changed. */ |
| |
| static wp_check_result |
| watchpoint_check (bpstat *bs) |
| { |
| struct watchpoint *b; |
| struct frame_info *fr; |
| int within_current_scope; |
| |
| /* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint. */ |
| gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL); |
| b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at; |
| |
| /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the |
| watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread |
| that was used to create the watchpoint. */ |
| if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b)) |
| return WP_IGNORE; |
| |
| if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL) |
| within_current_scope = 1; |
| else |
| { |
| struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame (); |
| struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame); |
| CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame); |
| |
| /* stack_frame_destroyed_p() returns a non-zero value if we're |
| still in the function but the stack frame has already been |
| invalidated. Since we can't rely on the values of local |
| variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating |
| the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further |
| checking. Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current |
| frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other |
| frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and |
| frame_find_by_id could error out. */ |
| if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc)) |
| return WP_IGNORE; |
| |
| fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame); |
| within_current_scope = (fr != NULL); |
| |
| /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have |
| returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */ |
| if (within_current_scope) |
| { |
| struct symbol *function; |
| |
| function = get_frame_function (fr); |
| if (function == NULL |
| || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block, function->value_block ())) |
| within_current_scope = 0; |
| } |
| |
| if (within_current_scope) |
| /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected |
| in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect |
| the user. */ |
| select_frame (fr); |
| } |
| |
| if (within_current_scope) |
| { |
| /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long* |
| time before we return to the command level and call |
| free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because we |
| might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */ |
| |
| struct value *mark; |
| struct value *new_val; |
| |
| if (is_masked_watchpoint (b)) |
| /* Since we don't know the exact trigger address (from |
| stopped_data_address), just tell the user we've triggered |
| a mask watchpoint. */ |
| return WP_VALUE_CHANGED; |
| |
| mark = value_mark (); |
| fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), b->exp->op.get (), &new_val, |
| NULL, NULL, false); |
| |
| if (b->val_bitsize != 0) |
| new_val = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, new_val); |
| |
| /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because |
| the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just |
| the address of the array instead of its contents. This is |
| not what we want. */ |
| if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL) |
| || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val.get (), |
| new_val))) |
| { |
| bs->old_val = b->val; |
| b->val = release_value (new_val); |
| b->val_valid = true; |
| if (new_val != NULL) |
| value_free_to_mark (mark); |
| return WP_VALUE_CHANGED; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* Nothing changed. */ |
| value_free_to_mark (mark); |
| return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED; |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because |
| if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when |
| we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains |
| garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two |
| garbage values, one before and one after the prologue). |
| So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and |
| watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal |
| the first value assigned). */ |
| /* We print all the stop information in |
| breakpointprint_it, but in this case, by the time we |
| call breakpoint->print_it this bp will be deleted |
| already. So we have no choice but print the information |
| here. */ |
| |
| SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS () |
| { |
| struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; |
| |
| if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) |
| uiout->field_string |
| ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE)); |
| uiout->message ("\nWatchpoint %pF deleted because the program has " |
| "left the block in\n" |
| "which its expression is valid.\n", |
| signed_field ("wpnum", b->number)); |
| } |
| |
| /* Make sure the watchpoint's commands aren't executed. */ |
| b->commands = NULL; |
| watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b); |
| |
| return WP_DELETED; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting |
| breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we should |
| stop, only if BL explains the stop. */ |
| |
| static int |
| bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl, |
| const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr, |
| const target_waitstatus &ws) |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner; |
| |
| /* BL is from an existing breakpoint. */ |
| gdb_assert (b != NULL); |
| |
| return b->breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws); |
| } |
| |
| /* Determine if the watched values have actually changed, and we |
| should stop. If not, set BS->stop to 0. */ |
| |
| static void |
| bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat *bs) |
| { |
| const struct bp_location *bl; |
| struct watchpoint *b; |
| |
| /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */ |
| bl = bs->bp_location_at.get (); |
| gdb_assert (bl != NULL); |
| b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at; |
| gdb_assert (b != NULL); |
| |
| { |
| int must_check_value = 0; |
| |
| if (b->type == bp_watchpoint) |
| /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the |
| watched value. */ |
| must_check_value = 1; |
| else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes) |
| /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access) |
| and the target earlier reported an address watched by |
| this watchpoint. */ |
| must_check_value = 1; |
| else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown |
| && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint) |
| /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could |
| not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's |
| value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without |
| a data address, we can't figure it out. */ |
| must_check_value = 1; |
| |
| if (must_check_value) |
| { |
| wp_check_result e; |
| |
| try |
| { |
| e = watchpoint_check (bs); |
| } |
| catch (const gdb_exception &ex) |
| { |
| exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex, |
| "Error evaluating expression " |
| "for watchpoint %d\n", |
| b->number); |
| |
| SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS () |
| { |
| gdb_printf (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"), |
| b->number); |
| } |
| watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b); |
| e = WP_DELETED; |
| } |
| |
| switch (e) |
| { |
| case WP_DELETED: |
| /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */ |
| bs->print_it = print_it_done; |
| /* Stop. */ |
| break; |
| case WP_IGNORE: |
| bs->print_it = print_it_noop; |
| bs->stop = 0; |
| break; |
| case WP_VALUE_CHANGED: |
| if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint) |
| { |
| /* There are two cases to consider here: |
| |
| 1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads. |
| In that case, trust the target, and always report |
| the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though |
| reads don't cause value changes, the value may |
| have changed since the last time it was read, and |
| since we're not trapping writes, we will not see |
| those, and as such we should ignore our notion of |
| old value. |
| |
| 2. We're watching the triggered memory for both |
| reads and writes. There are two ways this may |
| happen: |
| |
| 2.1. This is a target that can't break on data |
| reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or |
| writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case |
| at the time we try to insert read watchpoints. |
| |
| 2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read |
| watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write |
| watchpoint watching the same memory as this read |
| watchpoint. |
| |
| If we're watching memory writes as well as reads, |
| ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the |
| value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause |
| changes. This still gives false positives when |
| the program writes the same value to memory as |
| what there was already in memory (we will confuse |
| it for a read), but it's much better than |
| nothing. */ |
| |
| int other_write_watchpoint = 0; |
| |
| if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *other_b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| if (other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint |
| || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint) |
| { |
| struct watchpoint *other_w = |
| (struct watchpoint *) other_b; |
| |
| if (other_w->watchpoint_triggered |
| == watch_triggered_yes) |
| { |
| other_write_watchpoint = 1; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (other_write_watchpoint |
| || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access) |
| { |
| /* We're watching the same memory for writes, |
| and the value changed since the last time we |
| updated it, so this trap must be for a write. |
| Ignore it. */ |
| bs->print_it = print_it_noop; |
| bs->stop = 0; |
| } |
| } |
| break; |
| case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED: |
| if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint |
| || b->type == bp_watchpoint) |
| { |
| /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if |
| the value hasn't changed. */ |
| bs->print_it = print_it_noop; |
| bs->stop = 0; |
| } |
| /* Stop. */ |
| break; |
| default: |
| /* Can't happen. */ |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| else /* must_check_value == 0 */ |
| { |
| /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but |
| not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no |
| watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print |
| anything for this watchpoint. */ |
| bs->print_it = print_it_noop; |
| bs->stop = 0; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* For breakpoints that are currently marked as telling gdb to stop, |
| check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count) |
| of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this |
| breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */ |
| |
| static void |
| bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat *bs, thread_info *thread) |
| { |
| const struct bp_location *bl; |
| struct breakpoint *b; |
| /* Assume stop. */ |
| bool condition_result = true; |
| struct expression *cond; |
| |
| gdb_assert (bs->stop); |
| |
| /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */ |
| bl = bs->bp_location_at.get (); |
| gdb_assert (bl != NULL); |
| b = bs->breakpoint_at; |
| gdb_assert (b != NULL); |
| |
| /* Even if the target evaluated the condition on its end and notified GDB, we |
| need to do so again since GDB does not know if we stopped due to a |
| breakpoint or a single step breakpoint. */ |
| |
| if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id) |
| && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ()))) |
| { |
| bs->stop = 0; |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| /* If this is a thread/task-specific breakpoint, don't waste cpu |
| evaluating the condition if this isn't the specified |
| thread/task. */ |
| if ((b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread->global_num) |
| || (b->task != 0 && b->task != ada_get_task_number (thread))) |
| { |
| bs->stop = 0; |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| /* Evaluate extension language breakpoints that have a "stop" method |
| implemented. */ |
| bs->stop = breakpoint_ext_lang_cond_says_stop (b); |
| |
| if (is_watchpoint (b)) |
| { |
| struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b; |
| |
| cond = w->cond_exp.get (); |
| } |
| else |
| cond = bl->cond.get (); |
| |
| if (cond && b->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop) |
| { |
| int within_current_scope = 1; |
| struct watchpoint * w; |
| |
| /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could |
| be a long time before we return to the command level and |
| call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values |
| because we might be in the middle of evaluating a |
| function call. */ |
| struct value *mark = value_mark (); |
| |
| if (is_watchpoint (b)) |
| w = (struct watchpoint *) b; |
| else |
| w = NULL; |
| |
| /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that |
| the conditions will have the right context. Because we |
| use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's |
| variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start |
| of the inlined function; the current frame will be the |
| call site. */ |
| if (w == NULL || w->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL) |
| select_frame (get_current_frame ()); |
| else |
| { |
| struct frame_info *frame; |
| |
| /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular |
| instance of a local is being watched matters, so we |
| keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression |
| in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't |
| really matter which instantiation of the function |
| where the condition makes sense triggers the |
| watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch |
| global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to |
| global on all threads that call `func', or catch |
| writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single |
| thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in |
| the innermost frame that's executing where it makes |
| sense to evaluate the condition. It seems |
| intuitive. */ |
| frame = block_innermost_frame (w->cond_exp_valid_block); |
| if (frame != NULL) |
| select_frame (frame); |
| else |
| within_current_scope = 0; |
| } |
| if (within_current_scope) |
| { |
| try |
| { |
| condition_result = breakpoint_cond_eval (cond); |
| } |
| catch (const gdb_exception &ex) |
| { |
| exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex, |
| "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n"); |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested " |
| "in the current scope")); |
| /* If we failed to set the right context for this |
| watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */ |
| } |
| /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #. */ |
| value_free_to_mark (mark); |
| } |
| |
| if (cond && !condition_result) |
| { |
| bs->stop = 0; |
| } |
| else if (b->ignore_count > 0) |
| { |
| b->ignore_count--; |
| bs->stop = 0; |
| /* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop. */ |
| ++(b->hit_count); |
| gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Returns true if we need to track moribund locations of LOC's type |
| on the current target. */ |
| |
| static int |
| need_moribund_for_location_type (struct bp_location *loc) |
| { |
| return ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint |
| && !target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ()) |
| || (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint |
| && !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ())); |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| bpstat * |
| build_bpstat_chain (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr, |
| const target_waitstatus &ws) |
| { |
| bpstat *bs_head = nullptr, **bs_link = &bs_head; |
| |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| { |
| if (!breakpoint_enabled (b)) |
| continue; |
| |
| for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ()) |
| { |
| /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first |
| location. The watchpoint_check function will work on the |
| entire expression, not the individual locations. For |
| read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has |
| checked all locations already. */ |
| if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc) |
| break; |
| |
| if (!bl->enabled || bl->disabled_by_cond || bl->shlib_disabled) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws)) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address |
| matches. */ |
| |
| bpstat *bs = new bpstat (bl, &bs_link); /* Alloc a bpstat to |
| explain stop. */ |
| |
| /* Assume we stop. Should we find a watchpoint that is not |
| actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint |
| evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0. */ |
| bs->stop = 1; |
| bs->print = 1; |
| |
| /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated |
| watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the |
| out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next |
| iteration. */ |
| if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope && b->related_breakpoint != b) |
| { |
| struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b->related_breakpoint; |
| |
| w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Check if a moribund breakpoint explains the stop. */ |
| if (!target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint () |
| || !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ()) |
| { |
| for (bp_location *loc : moribund_locations) |
| { |
| if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, bp_addr) |
| && need_moribund_for_location_type (loc)) |
| { |
| bpstat *bs = new bpstat (loc, &bs_link); |
| /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */ |
| bs->stop = 0; |
| bs->print = 0; |
| bs->print_it = print_it_noop; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| return bs_head; |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| bpstat * |
| bpstat_stop_status (const address_space *aspace, |
| CORE_ADDR bp_addr, thread_info *thread, |
| const target_waitstatus &ws, |
| bpstat *stop_chain) |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *b = NULL; |
| /* First item of allocated bpstat's. */ |
| bpstat *bs_head = stop_chain; |
| bpstat *bs; |
| int need_remove_insert; |
| int removed_any; |
| |
| /* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a |
| target stop, while being careful to not set the target running, |
| as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint |
| locations are recreated). Resuming will happen here with |
| breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include |
| inferior function calls. */ |
| if (bs_head == NULL) |
| bs_head = build_bpstat_chain (aspace, bp_addr, ws); |
| |
| /* A bit of special processing for shlib breakpoints. We need to |
| process solib loading here, so that the lists of loaded and |
| unloaded libraries are correct before we handle "catch load" and |
| "catch unload". */ |
| for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) |
| { |
| if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event) |
| { |
| handle_solib_event (); |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and |
| check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher |
| layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently. */ |
| |
| removed_any = 0; |
| |
| for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) |
| { |
| if (!bs->stop) |
| continue; |
| |
| b = bs->breakpoint_at; |
| b->check_status (bs); |
| if (bs->stop) |
| { |
| bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, thread); |
| |
| if (bs->stop) |
| { |
| ++(b->hit_count); |
| |
| /* We will stop here. */ |
| if (b->disposition == disp_disable) |
| { |
| --(b->enable_count); |
| if (b->enable_count <= 0) |
| b->enable_state = bp_disabled; |
| removed_any = 1; |
| } |
| gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b); |
| if (b->silent) |
| bs->print = 0; |
| bs->commands = b->commands; |
| if (command_line_is_silent (bs->commands |
| ? bs->commands.get () : NULL)) |
| bs->print = 0; |
| |
| b->after_condition_true (bs); |
| } |
| |
| } |
| |
| /* Print nothing for this entry if we don't stop or don't |
| print. */ |
| if (!bs->stop || !bs->print) |
| bs->print_it = print_it_noop; |
| } |
| |
| /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may |
| not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are |
| watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get |
| done later. */ |
| need_remove_insert = 0; |
| if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head)) |
| for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) |
| if (!bs->stop |
| && bs->breakpoint_at |
| && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at)) |
| { |
| struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at; |
| |
| update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */); |
| need_remove_insert = 1; |
| } |
| |
| if (need_remove_insert) |
| update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); |
| else if (removed_any) |
| update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); |
| |
| return bs_head; |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| bpstat * |
| bpstat_stop_status_nowatch (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr, |
| thread_info *thread, const target_waitstatus &ws) |
| { |
| gdb_assert (!target_stopped_by_watchpoint ()); |
| |
| /* Clear all watchpoints' 'watchpoint_triggered' value from a |
| previous stop to avoid confusing bpstat_stop_status. */ |
| watchpoints_triggered (ws); |
| |
| return bpstat_stop_status (aspace, bp_addr, thread, ws); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| handle_jit_event (CORE_ADDR address) |
| { |
| struct gdbarch *gdbarch; |
| |
| infrun_debug_printf ("handling bp_jit_event"); |
| |
| /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by |
| breakpoint_re_set. */ |
| target_terminal::ours_for_output (); |
| |
| gdbarch = get_frame_arch (get_current_frame ()); |
| /* This event is caused by a breakpoint set in `jit_breakpoint_re_set`, |
| thus it is expected that its objectfile can be found through |
| minimal symbol lookup. If it doesn't work (and assert fails), it |
| most likely means that `jit_breakpoint_re_set` was changes and this |
| function needs to be updated too. */ |
| bound_minimal_symbol jit_bp_sym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (address); |
| gdb_assert (jit_bp_sym.objfile != nullptr); |
| jit_event_handler (gdbarch, jit_bp_sym.objfile); |
| |
| target_terminal::inferior (); |
| } |
| |
| /* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun. */ |
| |
| /* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat. */ |
| |
| struct bpstat_what |
| bpstat_what (bpstat *bs_head) |
| { |
| struct bpstat_what retval; |
| bpstat *bs; |
| |
| retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING; |
| retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE; |
| retval.is_longjmp = false; |
| |
| for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) |
| { |
| /* Extract this BS's action. After processing each BS, we check |
| if its action overrides all we've seem so far. */ |
| enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING; |
| enum bptype bptype; |
| |
| if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL) |
| { |
| /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary |
| breakpoint which has since been deleted. */ |
| bptype = bp_none; |
| } |
| else |
| bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->type; |
| |
| switch (bptype) |
| { |
| case bp_none: |
| break; |
| case bp_breakpoint: |
| case bp_hardware_breakpoint: |
| case bp_single_step: |
| case bp_until: |
| case bp_finish: |
| case bp_shlib_event: |
| if (bs->stop) |
| { |
| if (bs->print) |
| this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY; |
| else |
| this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT; |
| } |
| else |
| this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; |
| break; |
| case bp_watchpoint: |
| case bp_hardware_watchpoint: |
| case bp_read_watchpoint: |
| case bp_access_watchpoint: |
| if (bs->stop) |
| { |
| if (bs->print) |
| this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY; |
| else |
| this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping. |
| This requires no further action. */ |
| } |
| break; |
| case bp_longjmp: |
| case bp_longjmp_call_dummy: |
| case bp_exception: |
| if (bs->stop) |
| { |
| this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME; |
| retval.is_longjmp = bptype != bp_exception; |
| } |
| else |
| this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; |
| break; |
| case bp_longjmp_resume: |
| case bp_exception_resume: |
| if (bs->stop) |
| { |
| this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME; |
| retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp_resume; |
| } |
| else |
| this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; |
| break; |
| case bp_step_resume: |
| if (bs->stop) |
| this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME; |
| else |
| { |
| /* It is for the wrong frame. */ |
| this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; |
| } |
| break; |
| case bp_hp_step_resume: |
| if (bs->stop) |
| this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_HP_STEP_RESUME; |
| else |
| { |
| /* It is for the wrong frame. */ |
| this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; |
| } |
| break; |
| case bp_watchpoint_scope: |
| case bp_thread_event: |
| case bp_overlay_event: |
| case bp_longjmp_master: |
| case bp_std_terminate_master: |
| case bp_exception_master: |
| this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; |
| break; |
| case bp_catchpoint: |
| if (bs->stop) |
| { |
| if (bs->print) |
| this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY; |
| else |
| this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* Some catchpoints are implemented with breakpoints. |
| For those, we need to step over the breakpoint. */ |
| if (bs->bp_location_at->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint |
| || bs->bp_location_at->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) |
| this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; |
| } |
| break; |
| case bp_jit_event: |
| this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; |
| break; |
| case bp_call_dummy: |
| /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy), |
| so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */ |
| retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY; |
| this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT; |
| break; |
| case bp_std_terminate: |
| /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy), |
| so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */ |
| retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE; |
| this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT; |
| break; |
| case bp_tracepoint: |
| case bp_fast_tracepoint: |
| case bp_static_tracepoint: |
| case bp_static_marker_tracepoint: |
| /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and |
| if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered |
| out already. */ |
| internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, |
| _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered")); |
| break; |
| case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver: |
| /* Step over it (and insert bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return). */ |
| this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; |
| break; |
| case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return: |
| /* The breakpoint will be removed, execution will restart from the |
| PC of the former breakpoint. */ |
| this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING; |
| break; |
| |
| case bp_dprintf: |
| if (bs->stop) |
| this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT; |
| else |
| this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; |
| break; |
| |
| default: |
| internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, |
| _("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype); |
| } |
| |
| retval.main_action = std::max (retval.main_action, this_action); |
| } |
| |
| return retval; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| bpstat_run_callbacks (bpstat *bs_head) |
| { |
| bpstat *bs; |
| |
| for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at; |
| |
| if (b == NULL) |
| continue; |
| switch (b->type) |
| { |
| case bp_jit_event: |
| handle_jit_event (bs->bp_location_at->address); |
| break; |
| case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver: |
| gnu_ifunc_resolver_stop ((base_breakpoint *) b); |
| break; |
| case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return: |
| gnu_ifunc_resolver_return_stop ((base_breakpoint *) b); |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| bool |
| bpstat_should_step () |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL) |
| return true; |
| |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| bool |
| bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat *bs) |
| { |
| for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) |
| if (bs->stop) |
| return true; |
| |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| |
| |
| /* Compute a number of spaces suitable to indent the next line |
| so it starts at the position corresponding to the table column |
| named COL_NAME in the currently active table of UIOUT. */ |
| |
| static int |
| wrap_indent_at_field (struct ui_out *uiout, const char *col_name) |
| { |
| int i, total_width, width, align; |
| const char *text; |
| |
| total_width = 0; |
| for (i = 1; uiout->query_table_field (i, &width, &align, &text); i++) |
| { |
| if (strcmp (text, col_name) == 0) |
| return total_width; |
| |
| total_width += width + 1; |
| } |
| |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Determine if the locations of this breakpoint will have their conditions |
| evaluated by the target, host or a mix of both. Returns the following: |
| |
| "host": Host evals condition. |
| "host or target": Host or Target evals condition. |
| "target": Target evals condition. |
| */ |
| |
| static const char * |
| bp_condition_evaluator (const breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| char host_evals = 0; |
| char target_evals = 0; |
| |
| if (!b) |
| return NULL; |
| |
| if (!is_breakpoint (b)) |
| return NULL; |
| |
| if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p () |
| || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) |
| return condition_evaluation_host; |
| |
| for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ()) |
| { |
| if (bl->cond_bytecode) |
| target_evals++; |
| else |
| host_evals++; |
| } |
| |
| if (host_evals && target_evals) |
| return condition_evaluation_both; |
| else if (target_evals) |
| return condition_evaluation_target; |
| else |
| return condition_evaluation_host; |
| } |
| |
| /* Determine the breakpoint location's condition evaluator. This is |
| similar to bp_condition_evaluator, but for locations. */ |
| |
| static const char * |
| bp_location_condition_evaluator (struct bp_location *bl) |
| { |
| if (bl && !is_breakpoint (bl->owner)) |
| return NULL; |
| |
| if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p () |
| || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) |
| return condition_evaluation_host; |
| |
| if (bl && bl->cond_bytecode) |
| return condition_evaluation_target; |
| else |
| return condition_evaluation_host; |
| } |
| |
| /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */ |
| |
| static void |
| print_breakpoint_location (const breakpoint *b, |
| struct bp_location *loc) |
| { |
| struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; |
| |
| scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace; |
| |
| if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled) |
| loc = NULL; |
| |
| if (loc != NULL) |
| set_current_program_space (loc->pspace); |
| |
| if (b->display_canonical) |
| uiout->field_string ("what", event_location_to_string (b->location.get ())); |
| else if (loc && loc->symtab) |
| { |
| const struct symbol *sym = loc->symbol; |
| |
| if (sym) |
| { |
| uiout->text ("in "); |
| uiout->field_string ("func", sym->print_name (), |
| function_name_style.style ()); |
| uiout->text (" "); |
| uiout->wrap_hint (wrap_indent_at_field (uiout, "what")); |
| uiout->text ("at "); |
| } |
| uiout->field_string ("file", |
| symtab_to_filename_for_display (loc->symtab), |
| file_name_style.style ()); |
| uiout->text (":"); |
| |
| if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) |
| uiout->field_string ("fullname", symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab)); |
| |
| uiout->field_signed ("line", loc->line_number); |
| } |
| else if (loc) |
| { |
| string_file stb; |
| |
| print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, &stb, |
| demangle, ""); |
| uiout->field_stream ("at", stb); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| uiout->field_string ("pending", |
| event_location_to_string (b->location.get ())); |
| /* If extra_string is available, it could be holding a condition |
| or dprintf arguments. In either case, make sure it is printed, |
| too, but only for non-MI streams. */ |
| if (!uiout->is_mi_like_p () && b->extra_string != NULL) |
| { |
| if (b->type == bp_dprintf) |
| uiout->text (","); |
| else |
| uiout->text (" "); |
| uiout->text (b->extra_string.get ()); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (loc && is_breakpoint (b) |
| && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () == condition_evaluation_target |
| && bp_condition_evaluator (b) == condition_evaluation_both) |
| { |
| uiout->text (" ("); |
| uiout->field_string ("evaluated-by", |
| bp_location_condition_evaluator (loc)); |
| uiout->text (")"); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static const char * |
| bptype_string (enum bptype type) |
| { |
| struct ep_type_description |
| { |
| enum bptype type; |
| const char *description; |
| }; |
| static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] = |
| { |
| {bp_none, "?deleted?"}, |
| {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"}, |
| {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"}, |
| {bp_single_step, "sw single-step"}, |
| {bp_until, "until"}, |
| {bp_finish, "finish"}, |
| {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"}, |
| {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"}, |
| {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"}, |
| {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"}, |
| {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"}, |
| {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"}, |
| {bp_longjmp_call_dummy, "longjmp for call dummy"}, |
| {bp_exception, "exception"}, |
| {bp_exception_resume, "exception resume"}, |
| {bp_step_resume, "step resume"}, |
| {bp_hp_step_resume, "high-priority step resume"}, |
| {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"}, |
| {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"}, |
| {bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"}, |
| {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"}, |
| {bp_thread_event, "thread events"}, |
| {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"}, |
| {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"}, |
| {bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"}, |
| {bp_exception_master, "exception master"}, |
| {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"}, |
| {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"}, |
| {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"}, |
| {bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"}, |
| {bp_static_marker_tracepoint, "static marker tracepoint"}, |
| {bp_dprintf, "dprintf"}, |
| {bp_jit_event, "jit events"}, |
| {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver"}, |
| {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver return"}, |
| }; |
| |
| if (((int) type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0]))) |
| || ((int) type != bptypes[(int) type].type)) |
| internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, |
| _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."), |
| (int) type); |
| |
| return bptypes[(int) type].description; |
| } |
| |
| /* For MI, output a field named 'thread-groups' with a list as the value. |
| For CLI, prefix the list with the string 'inf'. */ |
| |
| static void |
| output_thread_groups (struct ui_out *uiout, |
| const char *field_name, |
| const std::vector<int> &inf_nums, |
| int mi_only) |
| { |
| int is_mi = uiout->is_mi_like_p (); |
| |
| /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless |
| there are several. Always display them for MI. */ |
| if (!is_mi && mi_only) |
| return; |
| |
| ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (uiout, field_name); |
| |
| for (size_t i = 0; i < inf_nums.size (); i++) |
| { |
| if (is_mi) |
| { |
| char mi_group[10]; |
| |
| xsnprintf (mi_group, sizeof (mi_group), "i%d", inf_nums[i]); |
| uiout->field_string (NULL, mi_group); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (i == 0) |
| uiout->text (" inf "); |
| else |
| uiout->text (", "); |
| |
| uiout->text (plongest (inf_nums[i])); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Print B to gdb_stdout. If RAW_LOC, print raw breakpoint locations |
| instead of going via breakpoint_ops::print_one. This makes "maint |
| info breakpoints" show the software breakpoint locations of |
| catchpoints, which are considered internal implementation |
| detail. Returns true if RAW_LOC is false and if the breakpoint's |
| print_one method did something; false otherwise. */ |
| |
| static bool |
| print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b, |
| struct bp_location *loc, |
| int loc_number, |
| struct bp_location **last_loc, |
| int allflag, bool raw_loc) |
| { |
| struct command_line *l; |
| static char bpenables[] = "nynny"; |
| |
| struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; |
| int header_of_multiple = 0; |
| int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL); |
| struct value_print_options opts; |
| |
| get_user_print_options (&opts); |
| |
| gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0); |
| /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of |
| breakpoints with single disabled location. */ |
| if (loc == NULL |
| && (b->loc != NULL |
| && (b->loc->next != NULL |
| || !b->loc->enabled || b->loc->disabled_by_cond))) |
| header_of_multiple = 1; |
| if (loc == NULL) |
| loc = b->loc; |
| |
| annotate_record (); |
| |
| /* 1 */ |
| annotate_field (0); |
| if (part_of_multiple) |
| uiout->field_fmt ("number", "%d.%d", b->number, loc_number); |
| else |
| uiout->field_signed ("number", b->number); |
| |
| /* 2 */ |
| annotate_field (1); |
| if (part_of_multiple) |
| uiout->field_skip ("type"); |
| else |
| uiout->field_string ("type", bptype_string (b->type)); |
| |
| /* 3 */ |
| annotate_field (2); |
| if (part_of_multiple) |
| uiout->field_skip ("disp"); |
| else |
| uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition)); |
| |
| /* 4 */ |
| annotate_field (3); |
| /* For locations that are disabled because of an invalid condition, |
| display "N*" on CLI, where "*" refers to a footnote below the |
| table. For MI, simply display a "N" without a footnote. */ |
| const char *N = (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) ? "N" : "N*"; |
| if (part_of_multiple) |
| uiout->field_string ("enabled", (loc->disabled_by_cond ? N |
| : (loc->enabled ? "y" : "n"))); |
| else |
| uiout->field_fmt ("enabled", "%c", bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]); |
| |
| /* 5 and 6 */ |
| bool result = false; |
| if (!raw_loc && b->print_one (last_loc)) |
| result = true; |
| else |
| { |
| if (is_watchpoint (b)) |
| { |
| struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b; |
| |
| /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns |
| not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect |
| is relatively readable). */ |
| if (opts.addressprint) |
| uiout->field_skip ("addr"); |
| annotate_field (5); |
| uiout->field_string ("what", w->exp_string.get ()); |
| } |
| else if (!is_catchpoint (b) || is_exception_catchpoint (b) |
| || is_ada_exception_catchpoint (b)) |
| { |
| if (opts.addressprint) |
| { |
| annotate_field (4); |
| if (header_of_multiple) |
| uiout->field_string ("addr", "<MULTIPLE>", |
| metadata_style.style ()); |
| else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled) |
| uiout->field_string ("addr", "<PENDING>", |
| metadata_style.style ()); |
| else |
| uiout->field_core_addr ("addr", |
| loc->gdbarch, loc->address); |
| } |
| annotate_field (5); |
| if (!header_of_multiple) |
| print_breakpoint_location (b, loc); |
| if (b->loc) |
| *last_loc = b->loc; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (loc != NULL && !header_of_multiple) |
| { |
| std::vector<int> inf_nums; |
| int mi_only = 1; |
| |
| for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ()) |
| { |
| if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace) |
| inf_nums.push_back (inf->num); |
| } |
| |
| /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless |
| there are several. Always display for MI. */ |
| if (allflag |
| || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()) |
| && (program_spaces.size () > 1 |
| || number_of_inferiors () > 1) |
| /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in |
| moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER. */ |
| && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint)) |
| mi_only = 0; |
| output_thread_groups (uiout, "thread-groups", inf_nums, mi_only); |
| } |
| |
| if (!part_of_multiple) |
| { |
| if (b->thread != -1) |
| { |
| /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the |
| "stop only in" line a little further down. */ |
| uiout->text (" thread "); |
| uiout->field_signed ("thread", b->thread); |
| } |
| else if (b->task != 0) |
| { |
| uiout->text (" task "); |
| uiout->field_signed ("task", b->task); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| uiout->text ("\n"); |
| |
| if (!part_of_multiple) |
| b->print_one_detail (uiout); |
| |
| if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id)) |
| { |
| annotate_field (6); |
| uiout->text ("\tstop only in stack frame at "); |
| /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poking around inside |
| the frame ID. */ |
| uiout->field_core_addr ("frame", |
| b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr); |
| uiout->text ("\n"); |
| } |
| |
| if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string) |
| { |
| annotate_field (7); |
| if (is_tracepoint (b)) |
| uiout->text ("\ttrace only if "); |
| else |
| uiout->text ("\tstop only if "); |
| uiout->field_string ("cond", b->cond_string.get ()); |
| |
| /* Print whether the target is doing the breakpoint's condition |
| evaluation. If GDB is doing the evaluation, don't print anything. */ |
| if (is_breakpoint (b) |
| && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () |
| == condition_evaluation_target) |
| { |
| uiout->message (" (%pF evals)", |
| string_field ("evaluated-by", |
| bp_condition_evaluator (b))); |
| } |
| uiout->text ("\n"); |
| } |
| |
| if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1) |
| { |
| /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */ |
| uiout->text ("\tstop only in thread "); |
| if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) |
| uiout->field_signed ("thread", b->thread); |
| else |
| { |
| struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (b->thread); |
| |
| uiout->field_string ("thread", print_thread_id (thr)); |
| } |
| uiout->text ("\n"); |
| } |
| |
| if (!part_of_multiple) |
| { |
| if (b->hit_count) |
| { |
| /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */ |
| if (is_catchpoint (b)) |
| uiout->text ("\tcatchpoint"); |
| else if (is_tracepoint (b)) |
| uiout->text ("\ttracepoint"); |
| else |
| uiout->text ("\tbreakpoint"); |
| uiout->text (" already hit "); |
| uiout->field_signed ("times", b->hit_count); |
| if (b->hit_count == 1) |
| uiout->text (" time\n"); |
| else |
| uiout->text (" times\n"); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi. */ |
| if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) |
| uiout->field_signed ("times", b->hit_count); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count) |
| { |
| annotate_field (8); |
| uiout->message ("\tignore next %pF hits\n", |
| signed_field ("ignore", b->ignore_count)); |
| } |
| |
| /* Note that an enable count of 1 corresponds to "enable once" |
| behavior, which is reported by the combination of enablement and |
| disposition, so we don't need to mention it here. */ |
| if (!part_of_multiple && b->enable_count > 1) |
| { |
| annotate_field (8); |
| uiout->text ("\tdisable after "); |
| /* Tweak the wording to clarify that ignore and enable counts |
| are distinct, and have additive effect. */ |
| if (b->ignore_count) |
| uiout->text ("additional "); |
| else |
| uiout->text ("next "); |
| uiout->field_signed ("enable", b->enable_count); |
| uiout->text (" hits\n"); |
| } |
| |
| if (!part_of_multiple && is_tracepoint (b)) |
| { |
| struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b; |
| |
| if (tp->traceframe_usage) |
| { |
| uiout->text ("\ttrace buffer usage "); |
| uiout->field_signed ("traceframe-usage", tp->traceframe_usage); |
| uiout->text (" bytes\n"); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| l = b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL; |
| if (!part_of_multiple && l) |
| { |
| annotate_field (9); |
| ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, "script"); |
| print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4); |
| } |
| |
| if (is_tracepoint (b)) |
| { |
| struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b; |
| |
| if (!part_of_multiple && t->pass_count) |
| { |
| annotate_field (10); |
| uiout->text ("\tpass count "); |
| uiout->field_signed ("pass", t->pass_count); |
| uiout->text (" \n"); |
| } |
| |
| /* Don't display it when tracepoint or tracepoint location is |
| pending. */ |
| if (!header_of_multiple && loc != NULL && !loc->shlib_disabled) |
| { |
| annotate_field (11); |
| |
| if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) |
| uiout->field_string ("installed", |
| loc->inserted ? "y" : "n"); |
| else |
| { |
| if (loc->inserted) |
| uiout->text ("\t"); |
| else |
| uiout->text ("\tnot "); |
| uiout->text ("installed on target\n"); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (uiout->is_mi_like_p () && !part_of_multiple) |
| { |
| if (is_watchpoint (b)) |
| { |
| struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b; |
| |
| uiout->field_string ("original-location", w->exp_string.get ()); |
| } |
| else if (b->location != NULL |
| && event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()) != NULL) |
| uiout->field_string ("original-location", |
| event_location_to_string (b->location.get ())); |
| } |
| |
| return result; |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| bool fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output_globally = false; |
| |
| static void |
| print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, |
| struct bp_location **last_loc, |
| int allflag) |
| { |
| struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; |
| bool use_fixed_output |
| = (uiout->test_flags (fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output) |
| || fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output_globally); |
| |
| gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> bkpt_tuple_emitter (gdb::in_place, uiout, "bkpt"); |
| bool printed = print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc, |
| allflag, false); |
| |
| /* The mi2 broken format: the main breakpoint tuple ends here, the locations |
| are outside. */ |
| if (!use_fixed_output) |
| bkpt_tuple_emitter.reset (); |
| |
| /* If this breakpoint has custom print function, |
| it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual |
| locations, if any. */ |
| if (!printed || allflag) |
| { |
| /* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we |
| print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's |
| hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled" |
| situation. |
| |
| Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations |
| internally, that's not a property exposed to users. |
| |
| Likewise, while catchpoints may be implemented with |
| breakpoints (e.g., catch throw), that's not a property |
| exposed to users. We do however display the internal |
| breakpoint locations with "maint info breakpoints". */ |
| if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (b) |
| && (!is_catchpoint (b) || is_exception_catchpoint (b) |
| || is_ada_exception_catchpoint (b)) |
| && (allflag |
| || (b->loc && (b->loc->next |
| || !b->loc->enabled |
| || b->loc->disabled_by_cond)))) |
| { |
| gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_list> locations_list; |
| |
| /* For MI version <= 2, keep the behavior where GDB outputs an invalid |
| MI record. For later versions, place breakpoint locations in a |
| list. */ |
| if (uiout->is_mi_like_p () && use_fixed_output) |
| locations_list.emplace (uiout, "locations"); |
| |
| int n = 1; |
| for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ()) |
| { |
| ui_out_emit_tuple loc_tuple_emitter (uiout, NULL); |
| print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc, |
| allflag, allflag); |
| n++; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static int |
| breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| int print_address_bits = 0; |
| |
| for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ()) |
| { |
| if (!bl_address_is_meaningful (loc)) |
| continue; |
| |
| int addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch); |
| if (addr_bit > print_address_bits) |
| print_address_bits = addr_bit; |
| } |
| |
| return print_address_bits; |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| void |
| print_breakpoint (breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL; |
| print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, 0); |
| } |
| |
| /* Return true if this breakpoint was set by the user, false if it is |
| internal or momentary. */ |
| |
| int |
| user_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| return b->number > 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| int |
| pending_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| return b->loc == NULL; |
| } |
| |
| /* Print information on breakpoints (including watchpoints and tracepoints). |
| |
| If non-NULL, BP_NUM_LIST is a list of numbers and number ranges as |
| understood by number_or_range_parser. Only breakpoints included in this |
| list are then printed. |
| |
| If SHOW_INTERNAL is true, print internal breakpoints. |
| |
| If FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the |
| ones for which it returns true. |
| |
| Return the total number of breakpoints listed. */ |
| |
| static int |
| breakpoint_1 (const char *bp_num_list, bool show_internal, |
| bool (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *)) |
| { |
| struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL; |
| int nr_printable_breakpoints; |
| struct value_print_options opts; |
| int print_address_bits = 0; |
| int print_type_col_width = 14; |
| struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; |
| bool has_disabled_by_cond_location = false; |
| |
| get_user_print_options (&opts); |
| |
| /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size |
| required for address fields. */ |
| nr_printable_breakpoints = 0; |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| { |
| /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */ |
| if (filter && !filter (b)) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* If we have a BP_NUM_LIST string, it is a list of breakpoints to |
| accept. Skip the others. */ |
| if (bp_num_list != NULL && *bp_num_list != '\0') |
| { |
| if (show_internal && parse_and_eval_long (bp_num_list) != b->number) |
| continue; |
| if (!show_internal && !number_is_in_list (bp_num_list, b->number)) |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| if (show_internal || user_breakpoint_p (b)) |
| { |
| int addr_bit, type_len; |
| |
| addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b); |
| if (addr_bit > print_address_bits) |
| print_address_bits = addr_bit; |
| |
| type_len = strlen (bptype_string (b->type)); |
| if (type_len > print_type_col_width) |
| print_type_col_width = type_len; |
| |
| nr_printable_breakpoints++; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| { |
| ui_out_emit_table table_emitter (uiout, |
| opts.addressprint ? 6 : 5, |
| nr_printable_breakpoints, |
| "BreakpointTable"); |
| |
| if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) |
| annotate_breakpoints_headers (); |
| if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) |
| annotate_field (0); |
| uiout->table_header (7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */ |
| if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) |
| annotate_field (1); |
| uiout->table_header (print_type_col_width, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */ |
| if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) |
| annotate_field (2); |
| uiout->table_header (4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */ |
| if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) |
| annotate_field (3); |
| uiout->table_header (3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */ |
| if (opts.addressprint) |
| { |
| if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) |
| annotate_field (4); |
| if (print_address_bits <= 32) |
| uiout->table_header (10, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */ |
| else |
| uiout->table_header (18, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */ |
| } |
| if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) |
| annotate_field (5); |
| uiout->table_header (40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */ |
| uiout->table_body (); |
| if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) |
| annotate_breakpoints_table (); |
| |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| { |
| QUIT; |
| /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */ |
| if (filter && !filter (b)) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* If we have a BP_NUM_LIST string, it is a list of breakpoints to |
| accept. Skip the others. */ |
| |
| if (bp_num_list != NULL && *bp_num_list != '\0') |
| { |
| if (show_internal) /* maintenance info breakpoint */ |
| { |
| if (parse_and_eval_long (bp_num_list) != b->number) |
| continue; |
| } |
| else /* all others */ |
| { |
| if (!number_is_in_list (bp_num_list, b->number)) |
| continue; |
| } |
| } |
| /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the |
| show_internal is set. */ |
| if (show_internal || user_breakpoint_p (b)) |
| { |
| print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, show_internal); |
| for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ()) |
| if (loc->disabled_by_cond) |
| has_disabled_by_cond_location = true; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0) |
| { |
| /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report |
| empty list. */ |
| if (!filter) |
| { |
| if (bp_num_list == NULL || *bp_num_list == '\0') |
| uiout->message ("No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n"); |
| else |
| uiout->message ("No breakpoint or watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", |
| bp_num_list); |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (last_loc && !server_command) |
| set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address); |
| |
| if (has_disabled_by_cond_location && !uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) |
| uiout->message (_("(*): Breakpoint condition is invalid at this " |
| "location.\n")); |
| } |
| |
| /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when |
| there have been breakpoints? */ |
| annotate_breakpoints_table_end (); |
| |
| return nr_printable_breakpoints; |
| } |
| |
| /* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally |
| compatible with the breakpoint list. */ |
| |
| static void |
| default_collect_info (void) |
| { |
| struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; |
| |
| /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a |
| message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's |
| not wanted. */ |
| if (default_collect.empty ()) |
| return; |
| |
| /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect |
| actions. */ |
| uiout->text ("default collect "); |
| uiout->field_string ("default-collect", default_collect); |
| uiout->text (" \n"); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| info_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty) |
| { |
| breakpoint_1 (args, false, NULL); |
| |
| default_collect_info (); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| info_watchpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty) |
| { |
| int num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, false, is_watchpoint); |
| struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; |
| |
| if (num_printed == 0) |
| { |
| if (args == NULL || *args == '\0') |
| uiout->message ("No watchpoints.\n"); |
| else |
| uiout->message ("No watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", args); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| maintenance_info_breakpoints (const char *args, int from_tty) |
| { |
| breakpoint_1 (args, true, NULL); |
| |
| default_collect_info (); |
| } |
| |
| static int |
| breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b, |
| struct program_space *pspace, |
| CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section) |
| { |
| for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ()) |
| { |
| if (bl->pspace == pspace |
| && bl->address == pc |
| && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section)) |
| return 1; |
| } |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| void |
| describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, |
| struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc, |
| struct obj_section *section, int thread) |
| { |
| int others = 0; |
| |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| others += (user_breakpoint_p (b) |
| && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section)); |
| |
| if (others > 0) |
| { |
| if (others == 1) |
| gdb_printf (_("Note: breakpoint ")); |
| else /* if (others == ???) */ |
| gdb_printf (_("Note: breakpoints ")); |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| if (user_breakpoint_p (b) && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section)) |
| { |
| others--; |
| gdb_printf ("%d", b->number); |
| if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1) |
| gdb_printf (" (all threads)"); |
| else if (b->thread != -1) |
| gdb_printf (" (thread %d)", b->thread); |
| gdb_printf ("%s%s ", |
| ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled |
| || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled) |
| ? " (disabled)" |
| : ""), |
| (others > 1) ? "," |
| : ((others == 1) ? " and" : "")); |
| } |
| current_uiout->message (_("also set at pc %ps.\n"), |
| styled_string (address_style.style (), |
| paddress (gdbarch, pc))); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| |
| /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of LOC. |
| For some breakpoint types, the locations' address members are |
| irrelevant and it makes no sense to attempt to compare them to |
| other addresses (or use them for any other purpose either). |
| |
| More specifically, software watchpoints and catchpoints that are |
| not backed by breakpoints always have a zero valued location |
| address and we don't want to mark breakpoints of any of these types |
| to be a duplicate of an actual breakpoint location at address |
| zero. */ |
| |
| static bool |
| bl_address_is_meaningful (bp_location *loc) |
| { |
| return loc->loc_type != bp_loc_other; |
| } |
| |
| /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns |
| true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */ |
| |
| static int |
| watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, |
| struct bp_location *loc2) |
| { |
| struct watchpoint *w1 = (struct watchpoint *) loc1->owner; |
| struct watchpoint *w2 = (struct watchpoint *) loc2->owner; |
| |
| /* Both of them must exist. */ |
| gdb_assert (w1 != NULL); |
| gdb_assert (w2 != NULL); |
| |
| /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware, |
| then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at |
| the same place. Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when |
| the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to |
| true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the |
| other watchpoint. */ |
| if ((w1->cond_exp |
| && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address, |
| loc1->length, |
| loc1->watchpoint_type, |
| w1->cond_exp.get ())) |
| || (w2->cond_exp |
| && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address, |
| loc2->length, |
| loc2->watchpoint_type, |
| w2->cond_exp.get ()))) |
| return 0; |
| |
| /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In |
| case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does |
| support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint |
| watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered |
| duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will |
| become hw_access locations later. */ |
| return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type |
| && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace |
| && loc1->address == loc2->address |
| && loc1->length == loc2->length); |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| int |
| breakpoint_address_match (const address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1, |
| const address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2) |
| { |
| return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()) |
| || aspace1 == aspace2) |
| && addr1 == addr2); |
| } |
| |
| /* Returns true if {ASPACE2,ADDR2} falls within the range determined by |
| {ASPACE1,ADDR1,LEN1}. In most targets, this can only be true if ASPACE1 |
| matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address |
| space doesn't really matter. */ |
| |
| static int |
| breakpoint_address_match_range (const address_space *aspace1, |
| CORE_ADDR addr1, |
| int len1, const address_space *aspace2, |
| CORE_ADDR addr2) |
| { |
| return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()) |
| || aspace1 == aspace2) |
| && addr2 >= addr1 && addr2 < addr1 + len1); |
| } |
| |
| /* Returns true if {ASPACE,ADDR} matches the breakpoint BL. BL may be |
| a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a match happens only if ASPACE |
| matches the breakpoint's address space. On targets that have global |
| breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */ |
| |
| static int |
| breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl, |
| const address_space *aspace, |
| CORE_ADDR addr) |
| { |
| return (breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address, |
| aspace, addr) |
| || (bl->length |
| && breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace, |
| bl->address, bl->length, |
| aspace, addr))); |
| } |
| |
| /* Returns true if the [ADDR,ADDR+LEN) range in ASPACE overlaps |
| breakpoint BL. BL may be a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a |
| match happens only if ASPACE matches the breakpoint's address |
| space. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address space |
| doesn't really matter. */ |
| |
| static int |
| breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *bl, |
| const address_space *aspace, |
| CORE_ADDR addr, int len) |
| { |
| if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()) |
| || bl->pspace->aspace == aspace) |
| { |
| int bl_len = bl->length != 0 ? bl->length : 1; |
| |
| if (mem_ranges_overlap (addr, len, bl->address, bl_len)) |
| return 1; |
| } |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* If LOC1 and LOC2's owners are not tracepoints, returns false directly. |
| Then, if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same tracepoint location, returns |
| true, otherwise returns false. */ |
| |
| static int |
| tracepoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, |
| struct bp_location *loc2) |
| { |
| if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) && is_tracepoint (loc2->owner)) |
| /* Since tracepoint locations are never duplicated with others', tracepoint |
| locations at the same address of different tracepoints are regarded as |
| different locations. */ |
| return (loc1->address == loc2->address && loc1->owner == loc2->owner); |
| else |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses |
| (bl_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent |
| the same location. If SW_HW_BPS_MATCH is true, then software |
| breakpoint locations and hardware breakpoint locations match, |
| otherwise they don't. */ |
| |
| static int |
| breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, |
| struct bp_location *loc2, |
| bool sw_hw_bps_match) |
| { |
| int hw_point1, hw_point2; |
| |
| /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */ |
| gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL); |
| gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL); |
| |
| hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner); |
| hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner); |
| |
| if (hw_point1 != hw_point2) |
| return 0; |
| else if (hw_point1) |
| return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2); |
| else if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) || is_tracepoint (loc2->owner)) |
| return tracepoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2); |
| else |
| /* We compare bp_location.length in order to cover ranged |
| breakpoints. Keep this in sync with |
| bp_location_is_less_than. */ |
| return (breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address, |
| loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address) |
| && (loc1->loc_type == loc2->loc_type || sw_hw_bps_match) |
| && loc1->length == loc2->length); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr, |
| int bnum, int have_bnum) |
| { |
| /* The longest string possibly returned by hex_string_custom |
| is 50 chars. These must be at least that big for safety. */ |
| char astr1[64]; |
| char astr2[64]; |
| |
| strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8)); |
| strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8)); |
| if (have_bnum) |
| warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."), |
| bnum, astr1, astr2); |
| else |
| warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2); |
| } |
| |
| /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural |
| constraints on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address. |
| Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most |
| targets, this function is simply the identity function. */ |
| |
| static CORE_ADDR |
| adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, |
| CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype) |
| { |
| if (bptype == bp_watchpoint |
| || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint |
| || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint |
| || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint |
| || bptype == bp_catchpoint) |
| { |
| /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not |
| have their addresses modified. */ |
| return bpaddr; |
| } |
| else if (bptype == bp_single_step) |
| { |
| /* Single-step breakpoints should not have their addresses |
| modified. If there's any architectural constrain that |
| applies to this address, then it should have already been |
| taken into account when the breakpoint was created in the |
| first place. If we didn't do this, stepping through e.g., |
| Thumb-2 IT blocks would break. */ |
| return bpaddr; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr = bpaddr; |
| |
| if (gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch)) |
| { |
| /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement |
| of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */ |
| adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr); |
| } |
| |
| adjusted_bpaddr = address_significant (gdbarch, adjusted_bpaddr); |
| |
| /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter |
| a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment |
| is required. */ |
| if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr) |
| breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0); |
| |
| return adjusted_bpaddr; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static bp_loc_type |
| bp_location_from_bp_type (bptype type) |
| { |
| switch (type) |
| { |
| case bp_breakpoint: |
| case bp_single_step: |
| case bp_until: |
| case bp_finish: |
| case bp_longjmp: |
| case bp_longjmp_resume: |
| case bp_longjmp_call_dummy: |
| case bp_exception: |
| case bp_exception_resume: |
| case bp_step_resume: |
| case bp_hp_step_resume: |
| case bp_watchpoint_scope: |
| case bp_call_dummy: |
| case bp_std_terminate: |
| case bp_shlib_event: |
| case bp_thread_event: |
| case bp_overlay_event: |
| case bp_jit_event: |
| case bp_longjmp_master: |
| case bp_std_terminate_master: |
| case bp_exception_master: |
| case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver: |
| case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return: |
| case bp_dprintf: |
| return bp_loc_software_breakpoint; |
| case bp_hardware_breakpoint: |
| return bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint; |
| case bp_hardware_watchpoint: |
| case bp_read_watchpoint: |
| case bp_access_watchpoint: |
| return bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint; |
| case bp_watchpoint: |
| return bp_loc_software_watchpoint; |
| case bp_catchpoint: |
| case bp_tracepoint: |
| case bp_fast_tracepoint: |
| case bp_static_tracepoint: |
| case bp_static_marker_tracepoint: |
| return bp_loc_other; |
| default: |
| internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type")); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| bp_location::bp_location (breakpoint *owner, bp_loc_type type) |
| { |
| this->owner = owner; |
| this->cond_bytecode = NULL; |
| this->shlib_disabled = 0; |
| this->enabled = 1; |
| this->disabled_by_cond = false; |
| |
| this->loc_type = type; |
| |
| if (this->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint |
| || this->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) |
| mark_breakpoint_location_modified (this); |
| |
| incref (); |
| } |
| |
| bp_location::bp_location (breakpoint *owner) |
| : bp_location::bp_location (owner, |
| bp_location_from_bp_type (owner->type)) |
| { |
| } |
| |
| /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0, |
| destroy the bp_location. Sets *BLP to NULL. */ |
| |
| static void |
| decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **blp) |
| { |
| bp_location_ref_policy::decref (*blp); |
| *blp = NULL; |
| } |
| |
| /* Add breakpoint B at the end of the global breakpoint chain. */ |
| |
| static breakpoint * |
| add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&b) |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *b1; |
| struct breakpoint *result = b.get (); |
| |
| /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of |
| breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers. */ |
| |
| b1 = breakpoint_chain; |
| if (b1 == 0) |
| breakpoint_chain = b.release (); |
| else |
| { |
| while (b1->next) |
| b1 = b1->next; |
| b1->next = b.release (); |
| } |
| |
| return result; |
| } |
| |
| /* Initialize loc->function_name. */ |
| |
| static void |
| set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc) |
| { |
| gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL); |
| |
| if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint |
| || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint |
| || is_tracepoint (loc->owner)) |
| { |
| const char *function_name; |
| |
| if (loc->msymbol != NULL |
| && (loc->msymbol->type () == mst_text_gnu_ifunc |
| || loc->msymbol->type () == mst_data_gnu_ifunc)) |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner; |
| |
| function_name = loc->msymbol->linkage_name (); |
| |
| if (b->type == bp_breakpoint && b->loc == loc |
| && loc->next == NULL && b->related_breakpoint == b) |
| { |
| /* Create only the whole new breakpoint of this type but do not |
| mess more complicated breakpoints with multiple locations. */ |
| b->type = bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver; |
| /* Remember the resolver's address for use by the return |
| breakpoint. */ |
| loc->related_address = loc->address; |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &function_name, NULL, NULL); |
| |
| if (function_name) |
| loc->function_name = make_unique_xstrdup (function_name); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */ |
| struct gdbarch * |
| get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal) |
| { |
| if (sal.section) |
| return sal.section->objfile->arch (); |
| if (sal.symtab) |
| return sal.symtab->compunit ()->objfile ()->arch (); |
| |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| |
| /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint |
| if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP. FRAME is the frame which |
| initiated the operation. */ |
| |
| void |
| set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info *tp, struct frame_id frame) |
| { |
| int thread = tp->global_num; |
| |
| /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step, |
| we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled |
| longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary |
| clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */ |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) |
| if (b->pspace == current_program_space |
| && (b->type == bp_longjmp_master |
| || b->type == bp_exception_master)) |
| { |
| enum bptype type = b->type == bp_longjmp_master ? bp_longjmp : bp_exception; |
| struct breakpoint *clone; |
| |
| /* longjmp_breakpoint_ops ensures INITIATING_FRAME is cleared again |
| after their removal. */ |
| clone = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, type, 1); |
| clone->thread = thread; |
| } |
| |
| tp->initiating_frame = frame; |
| } |
| |
| /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */ |
| void |
| delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) |
| if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception) |
| { |
| if (b->thread == thread) |
| delete_breakpoint (b); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| void |
| delete_longjmp_breakpoint_at_next_stop (int thread) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) |
| if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception) |
| { |
| if (b->thread == thread) |
| b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Place breakpoints of type bp_longjmp_call_dummy to catch longjmp for |
| INFERIOR_PTID thread. Chain them all by RELATED_BREAKPOINT and return |
| pointer to any of them. Return NULL if this system cannot place longjmp |
| breakpoints. */ |
| |
| struct breakpoint * |
| set_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (void) |
| { |
| breakpoint *retval = nullptr; |
| |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| if (b->pspace == current_program_space && b->type == bp_longjmp_master) |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *new_b; |
| |
| new_b = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_longjmp_call_dummy, |
| 1); |
| new_b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num; |
| |
| /* Link NEW_B into the chain of RETVAL breakpoints. */ |
| |
| gdb_assert (new_b->related_breakpoint == new_b); |
| if (retval == NULL) |
| retval = new_b; |
| new_b->related_breakpoint = retval; |
| while (retval->related_breakpoint != new_b->related_breakpoint) |
| retval = retval->related_breakpoint; |
| retval->related_breakpoint = new_b; |
| } |
| |
| return retval; |
| } |
| |
| /* Verify all existing dummy frames and their associated breakpoints for |
| TP. Remove those which can no longer be found in the current frame |
| stack. |
| |
| If the unwind fails then there is not sufficient information to discard |
| dummy frames. In this case, elide the clean up and the dummy frames will |
| be cleaned up next time this function is called from a location where |
| unwinding is possible. */ |
| |
| void |
| check_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (struct thread_info *tp) |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp; |
| |
| ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp) |
| if (b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy && b->thread == tp->global_num) |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *dummy_b = b->related_breakpoint; |
| |
| /* Find the bp_call_dummy breakpoint in the list of breakpoints |
| chained off b->related_breakpoint. */ |
| while (dummy_b != b && dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy) |
| dummy_b = dummy_b->related_breakpoint; |
| |
| /* If there was no bp_call_dummy breakpoint then there's nothing |
| more to do. Or, if the dummy frame associated with the |
| bp_call_dummy is still on the stack then we need to leave this |
| bp_call_dummy in place. */ |
| if (dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy |
| || frame_find_by_id (dummy_b->frame_id) != NULL) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* We didn't find the dummy frame on the stack, this could be |
| because we have longjmp'd to a stack frame that is previous to |
| the dummy frame, or it could be because the stack unwind is |
| broken at some point between the longjmp frame and the dummy |
| frame. |
| |
| Next we figure out why the stack unwind stopped. If it looks |
| like the unwind is complete then we assume the dummy frame has |
| been jumped over, however, if the unwind stopped for an |
| unexpected reason then we assume the stack unwind is currently |
| broken, and that we will (eventually) return to the dummy |
| frame. |
| |
| It might be tempting to consider using frame_id_inner here, but |
| that is not safe. There is no guarantee that the stack frames |
| we are looking at here are even on the same stack as the |
| original dummy frame, hence frame_id_inner can't be used. See |
| the comments on frame_id_inner for more details. */ |
| bool unwind_finished_unexpectedly = false; |
| for (struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame (); fi != nullptr; ) |
| { |
| struct frame_info *prev = get_prev_frame (fi); |
| if (prev == nullptr) |
| { |
| /* FI is the last stack frame. Why did this frame not |
| unwind further? */ |
| auto stop_reason = get_frame_unwind_stop_reason (fi); |
| if (stop_reason != UNWIND_NO_REASON |
| && stop_reason != UNWIND_OUTERMOST) |
| unwind_finished_unexpectedly = true; |
| } |
| fi = prev; |
| } |
| if (unwind_finished_unexpectedly) |
| continue; |
| |
| dummy_frame_discard (dummy_b->frame_id, tp); |
| |
| while (b->related_breakpoint != b) |
| { |
| if (b_tmp == b->related_breakpoint) |
| b_tmp = b->related_breakpoint->next; |
| delete_breakpoint (b->related_breakpoint); |
| } |
| delete_breakpoint (b); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| void |
| enable_overlay_breakpoints (void) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| if (b->type == bp_overlay_event) |
| { |
| b->enable_state = bp_enabled; |
| update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); |
| overlay_events_enabled = 1; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| void |
| disable_overlay_breakpoints (void) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| if (b->type == bp_overlay_event) |
| { |
| b->enable_state = bp_disabled; |
| update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); |
| overlay_events_enabled = 0; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate |
| master breakpoint. */ |
| void |
| set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) |
| if (b->pspace == current_program_space |
| && b->type == bp_std_terminate_master) |
| { |
| momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_std_terminate, 1); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints. */ |
| void |
| delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) |
| if (b->type == bp_std_terminate) |
| delete_breakpoint (b); |
| } |
| |
| struct breakpoint * |
| create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address) |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *b; |
| |
| b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event); |
| |
| b->enable_state = bp_enabled; |
| /* location has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */ |
| b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0); |
| |
| update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); |
| |
| return b; |
| } |
| |
| struct lang_and_radix |
| { |
| enum language lang; |
| int radix; |
| }; |
| |
| /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */ |
| |
| struct breakpoint * |
| create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address) |
| { |
| return create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event); |
| } |
| |
| /* Remove JIT code registration and unregistration breakpoint(s). */ |
| |
| void |
| remove_jit_event_breakpoints (void) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) |
| if (b->type == bp_jit_event |
| && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space) |
| delete_breakpoint (b); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) |
| if (b->type == bp_shlib_event |
| && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space) |
| delete_breakpoint (b); |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| void |
| remove_solib_event_breakpoints_at_next_stop (void) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) |
| if (b->type == bp_shlib_event |
| && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space) |
| b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop; |
| } |
| |
| /* Helper for create_solib_event_breakpoint / |
| create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint. Allows specifying which |
| INSERT_MODE to pass through to update_global_location_list. */ |
| |
| static struct breakpoint * |
| create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address, |
| enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode) |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *b; |
| |
| b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event); |
| update_global_location_list_nothrow (insert_mode); |
| return b; |
| } |
| |
| struct breakpoint * |
| create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address) |
| { |
| return create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_MAY_INSERT); |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| struct breakpoint * |
| create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address) |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *b; |
| |
| /* Explicitly tell update_global_location_list to insert |
| locations. */ |
| b = create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_INSERT); |
| if (!b->loc->inserted) |
| { |
| delete_breakpoint (b); |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| return b; |
| } |
| |
| /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only |
| apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */ |
| |
| void |
| disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void) |
| { |
| for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ()) |
| { |
| /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */ |
| struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner; |
| |
| /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled for |
| those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint |
| becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to |
| insert all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here, |
| we'll try to insert those breakpoints and fail. */ |
| if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint) |
| || (b->type == bp_jit_event) |
| || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint) |
| || (is_tracepoint (b))) |
| && loc->pspace == current_program_space |
| && !loc->shlib_disabled |
| && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address) |
| ) |
| { |
| loc->shlib_disabled = 1; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints that are in SOLIB upon |
| notification of unloaded_shlib. Only apply to enabled breakpoints, |
| disabled ones can just stay disabled. */ |
| |
| static void |
| disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib) |
| { |
| int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0; |
| |
| for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ()) |
| { |
| /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */ |
| struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner; |
| |
| if (solib->pspace == loc->pspace |
| && !loc->shlib_disabled |
| && (((b->type == bp_breakpoint |
| || b->type == bp_jit_event |
| || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint) |
| && (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint |
| || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint)) |
| || is_tracepoint (b)) |
| && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address)) |
| { |
| loc->shlib_disabled = 1; |
| /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint |
| succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted |
| to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */ |
| loc->inserted = 0; |
| |
| /* This may cause duplicate notifications for the same breakpoint. */ |
| gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b); |
| |
| if (!disabled_shlib_breaks) |
| { |
| target_terminal::ours_for_output (); |
| warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints " |
| "for unloaded shared library \"%s\""), |
| solib->so_name); |
| } |
| disabled_shlib_breaks = 1; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints in OBJFILE upon |
| notification of free_objfile. Only apply to enabled breakpoints, |
| disabled ones can just stay disabled. */ |
| |
| static void |
| disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile (struct objfile *objfile) |
| { |
| if (objfile == NULL) |
| return; |
| |
| /* OBJF_SHARED|OBJF_USERLOADED objfiles are dynamic modules manually |
| managed by the user with add-symbol-file/remove-symbol-file. |
| Similarly to how breakpoints in shared libraries are handled in |
| response to "nosharedlibrary", mark breakpoints in such modules |
| shlib_disabled so they end up uninserted on the next global |
| location list update. Shared libraries not loaded by the user |
| aren't handled here -- they're already handled in |
| disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, called by solib.c's |
| solib_unloaded observer. We skip objfiles that are not |
| OBJF_SHARED as those aren't considered dynamic objects (e.g. the |
| main objfile). */ |
| if ((objfile->flags & OBJF_SHARED) == 0 |
| || (objfile->flags & OBJF_USERLOADED) == 0) |
| return; |
| |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| { |
| int bp_modified = 0; |
| |
| if (!is_breakpoint (b) && !is_tracepoint (b)) |
| continue; |
| |
| for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ()) |
| { |
| CORE_ADDR loc_addr = loc->address; |
| |
| if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint |
| && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (loc->shlib_disabled != 0) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (objfile->pspace != loc->pspace) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint |
| && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (is_addr_in_objfile (loc_addr, objfile)) |
| { |
| loc->shlib_disabled = 1; |
| /* At this point, we don't know whether the object was |
| unmapped from the inferior or not, so leave the |
| inserted flag alone. We'll handle failure to |
| uninsert quietly, in case the object was indeed |
| unmapped. */ |
| |
| mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc); |
| |
| bp_modified = 1; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (bp_modified) |
| gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| breakpoint::breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch_, enum bptype bptype, |
| bool temp, const char *cond_string_) |
| : type (bptype), |
| disposition (temp ? disp_del : disp_donttouch), |
| gdbarch (gdbarch_), |
| language (current_language->la_language), |
| input_radix (::input_radix), |
| cond_string (cond_string_ != nullptr |
| ? make_unique_xstrdup (cond_string_) |
| : nullptr), |
| related_breakpoint (this) |
| { |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| catchpoint::catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, bool temp, |
| const char *cond_string) |
| : breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_catchpoint, temp, cond_string) |
| { |
| add_dummy_location (this, current_program_space); |
| |
| pspace = current_program_space; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| install_breakpoint (int internal, std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&arg, int update_gll) |
| { |
| breakpoint *b = add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (arg)); |
| set_breakpoint_number (internal, b); |
| if (is_tracepoint (b)) |
| set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count); |
| if (!internal) |
| mention (b); |
| gdb::observers::breakpoint_created.notify (b); |
| |
| if (update_gll) |
| update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); |
| } |
| |
| static int |
| hw_breakpoint_used_count (void) |
| { |
| int i = 0; |
| |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b)) |
| for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ()) |
| { |
| /* Special types of hardware breakpoints may use more than |
| one register. */ |
| i += b->resources_needed (bl); |
| } |
| |
| return i; |
| } |
| |
| /* Returns the resources B would use if it were a hardware |
| watchpoint. */ |
| |
| static int |
| hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| int i = 0; |
| |
| if (!breakpoint_enabled (b)) |
| return 0; |
| |
| for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ()) |
| { |
| /* Special types of hardware watchpoints may use more than |
| one register. */ |
| i += b->resources_needed (bl); |
| } |
| |
| return i; |
| } |
| |
| /* Returns the sum the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of |
| type TYPE in the breakpoints list. Also returns in OTHER_TYPE_USED |
| the sum of the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of other |
| types _not_ TYPE. */ |
| |
| static int |
| hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except, |
| enum bptype type, int *other_type_used) |
| { |
| int i = 0; |
| |
| *other_type_used = 0; |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| { |
| if (b == except) |
| continue; |
| if (!breakpoint_enabled (b)) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (b->type == type) |
| i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b); |
| else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)) |
| *other_type_used = 1; |
| } |
| |
| return i; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| if (is_watchpoint (b) && breakpoint_enabled (b)) |
| { |
| b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled; |
| update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| void |
| enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| if (is_watchpoint (b) && b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled) |
| { |
| b->enable_state = bp_enabled; |
| update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| void |
| disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void) |
| { |
| current_program_space->executing_startup = 1; |
| update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void) |
| { |
| current_program_space->executing_startup = 0; |
| breakpoint_re_set (); |
| } |
| |
| /* Allocate a new momentary breakpoint. */ |
| |
| static momentary_breakpoint * |
| new_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, enum bptype type) |
| { |
| if (type == bp_longjmp || type == bp_exception) |
| return new longjmp_breakpoint (gdbarch, type); |
| else |
| return new momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, type); |
| } |
| |
| /* Set a momentary breakpoint of type TYPE at address specified by |
| SAL. If FRAME_ID is valid, the breakpoint is restricted to that |
| frame. */ |
| |
| breakpoint_up |
| set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal, |
| struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type) |
| { |
| /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined or |
| tail-called one. */ |
| gdb_assert (!frame_id_artificial_p (frame_id)); |
| |
| std::unique_ptr<momentary_breakpoint> b |
| (new_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, type)); |
| |
| b->add_location (sal); |
| b->pspace = sal.pspace; |
| b->enable_state = bp_enabled; |
| b->disposition = disp_donttouch; |
| b->frame_id = frame_id; |
| |
| b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num; |
| |
| breakpoint_up bp (add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b))); |
| |
| update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); |
| |
| return bp; |
| } |
| |
| /* Make a momentary breakpoint based on the master breakpoint ORIG. |
| The new breakpoint will have type TYPE, use OPS as its |
| breakpoint_ops, and will set enabled to LOC_ENABLED. */ |
| |
| static struct breakpoint * |
| momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig, |
| enum bptype type, |
| int loc_enabled) |
| { |
| std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> copy |
| (new_momentary_breakpoint (orig->gdbarch, type)); |
| copy->loc = copy->allocate_location (); |
| set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc); |
| |
| copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch; |
| copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address; |
| copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address; |
| copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section; |
| copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace; |
| copy->loc->probe = orig->loc->probe; |
| copy->loc->line_number = orig->loc->line_number; |
| copy->loc->symtab = orig->loc->symtab; |
| copy->loc->enabled = loc_enabled; |
| copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id; |
| copy->thread = orig->thread; |
| copy->pspace = orig->pspace; |
| |
| copy->enable_state = bp_enabled; |
| copy->disposition = disp_donttouch; |
| copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--; |
| |
| breakpoint *b = add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (copy)); |
| update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); |
| return b; |
| } |
| |
| /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if |
| ORIG is NULL. */ |
| |
| struct breakpoint * |
| clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig) |
| { |
| /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */ |
| if (orig == NULL) |
| return NULL; |
| |
| return momentary_breakpoint_from_master (orig, orig->type, 0); |
| } |
| |
| breakpoint_up |
| set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc, |
| enum bptype type) |
| { |
| struct symtab_and_line sal; |
| |
| sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0); |
| sal.pc = pc; |
| sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc); |
| sal.explicit_pc = 1; |
| |
| return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type); |
| } |
| |
| |
| /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */ |
| |
| static void |
| mention (const breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| b->print_mention (); |
| current_uiout->text ("\n"); |
| } |
| |
| |
| static bool bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc); |
| |
| /* Handle "set breakpoint auto-hw on". |
| |
| If the explicitly specified breakpoint type is not hardware |
| breakpoint, check the memory map to see whether the breakpoint |
| address is in read-only memory. |
| |
| - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory is read-only. |
| We change the type of the location to hardware breakpoint. |
| |
| - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is read-write. This |
| means we've previously made the location hardware one, but then the |
| memory map changed, so we undo. |
| */ |
| |
| static void |
| handle_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (bp_location *bl) |
| { |
| if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints |
| && bl->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint |
| && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint |
| || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)) |
| { |
| /* When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use |
| location types we've just set here, the only possible problem |
| is that memory map has changed during running program, but |
| it's not going to work anyway with current gdb. */ |
| mem_region *mr = lookup_mem_region (bl->address); |
| |
| if (mr != nullptr) |
| { |
| enum bp_loc_type new_type; |
| |
| if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW) |
| new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint; |
| else |
| new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint; |
| |
| if (new_type != bl->loc_type) |
| { |
| static bool said = false; |
| |
| bl->loc_type = new_type; |
| if (!said) |
| { |
| gdb_printf (_("Note: automatically using " |
| "hardware breakpoints for " |
| "read-only addresses.\n")); |
| said = true; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| bp_location * |
| base_breakpoint::add_location (const symtab_and_line &sal) |
| { |
| struct bp_location *new_loc, **tmp; |
| CORE_ADDR adjusted_address; |
| struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal); |
| |
| if (loc_gdbarch == NULL) |
| loc_gdbarch = gdbarch; |
| |
| /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location. |
| Once we call allocate_location(), that mostly uninitialized |
| location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the |
| breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do |
| not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and |
| location that's only been partially initialized. */ |
| adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch, |
| sal.pc, type); |
| |
| /* Sort the locations by their ADDRESS. */ |
| new_loc = allocate_location (); |
| for (tmp = &(loc); *tmp != NULL && (*tmp)->address <= adjusted_address; |
| tmp = &((*tmp)->next)) |
| ; |
| new_loc->next = *tmp; |
| *tmp = new_loc; |
| |
| new_loc->requested_address = sal.pc; |
| new_loc->address = adjusted_address; |
| new_loc->pspace = sal.pspace; |
| new_loc->probe.prob = sal.prob; |
| new_loc->probe.objfile = sal.objfile; |
| gdb_assert (new_loc->pspace != NULL); |
| new_loc->section = sal.section; |
| new_loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch; |
| new_loc->line_number = sal.line; |
| new_loc->symtab = sal.symtab; |
| new_loc->symbol = sal.symbol; |
| new_loc->msymbol = sal.msymbol; |
| new_loc->objfile = sal.objfile; |
| |
| set_breakpoint_location_function (new_loc); |
| |
| /* While by definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the |
| code, we don't mark the location as inserted. Normally one would expect |
| that GDB could rely on that breakpoint instruction to stop the program, |
| thus removing the need to insert its own breakpoint, except that executing |
| the breakpoint instruction can kill the target instead of reporting a |
| SIGTRAP. E.g., on SPARC, when interrupts are disabled, executing the |
| instruction resets the CPU, so QEMU 2.0.0 for SPARC correspondingly dies |
| with "Trap 0x02 while interrupts disabled, Error state". Letting the |
| breakpoint be inserted normally results in QEMU knowing about the GDB |
| breakpoint, and thus trap before the breakpoint instruction is executed. |
| (If GDB later needs to continue execution past the permanent breakpoint, |
| it manually increments the PC, thus avoiding executing the breakpoint |
| instruction.) */ |
| if (bp_loc_is_permanent (new_loc)) |
| new_loc->permanent = 1; |
| |
| return new_loc; |
| } |
| |
| |
| /* Return true if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint, |
| return false otherwise. */ |
| |
| static bool |
| bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc) |
| { |
| gdb_assert (loc != NULL); |
| |
| /* If we have a non-breakpoint-backed catchpoint or a software |
| watchpoint, just return 0. We should not attempt to read from |
| the addresses the locations of these breakpoint types point to. |
| gdbarch_program_breakpoint_here_p, below, will attempt to read |
| memory. */ |
| if (!bl_address_is_meaningful (loc)) |
| return false; |
| |
| scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread; |
| switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace); |
| return gdbarch_program_breakpoint_here_p (loc->gdbarch, loc->address); |
| } |
| |
| /* Build a command list for the dprintf corresponding to the current |
| settings of the dprintf style options. */ |
| |
| static void |
| update_dprintf_command_list (struct breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| const char *dprintf_args = b->extra_string.get (); |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> printf_line = nullptr; |
| |
| if (!dprintf_args) |
| return; |
| |
| dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args); |
| |
| /* Allow a comma, as it may have terminated a location, but don't |
| insist on it. */ |
| if (*dprintf_args == ',') |
| ++dprintf_args; |
| dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args); |
| |
| if (*dprintf_args != '"') |
| error (_("Bad format string, missing '\"'.")); |
| |
| if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_gdb) == 0) |
| printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args); |
| else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_call) == 0) |
| { |
| if (dprintf_function.empty ()) |
| error (_("No function supplied for dprintf call")); |
| |
| if (!dprintf_channel.empty ()) |
| printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s,%s)", |
| dprintf_function.c_str (), |
| dprintf_channel.c_str (), |
| dprintf_args); |
| else |
| printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s)", |
| dprintf_function.c_str (), |
| dprintf_args); |
| } |
| else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_agent) == 0) |
| { |
| if (target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ()) |
| printf_line = xstrprintf ("agent-printf %s", dprintf_args); |
| else |
| { |
| warning (_("Target cannot run dprintf commands, falling back to GDB printf")); |
| printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args); |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, |
| _("Invalid dprintf style.")); |
| |
| gdb_assert (printf_line != NULL); |
| |
| /* Manufacture a printf sequence. */ |
| struct command_line *printf_cmd_line |
| = new struct command_line (simple_control, printf_line.release ()); |
| breakpoint_set_commands (b, counted_command_line (printf_cmd_line, |
| command_lines_deleter ())); |
| } |
| |
| /* Update all dprintf commands, making their command lists reflect |
| current style settings. */ |
| |
| static void |
| update_dprintf_commands (const char *args, int from_tty, |
| struct cmd_list_element *c) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| if (b->type == bp_dprintf) |
| update_dprintf_command_list (b); |
| } |
| |
| base_breakpoint::base_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch_, |
| enum bptype type_, |
| gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals, |
| event_location_up &&location_, |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter_, |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string_, |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string_, |
| enum bpdisp disposition_, |
| int thread_, int task_, int ignore_count_, |
| int from_tty, |
| int enabled_, unsigned flags, |
| int display_canonical_) |
| : breakpoint (gdbarch_, type_) |
| { |
| int i; |
| |
| if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint) |
| { |
| int target_resources_ok; |
| |
| i = hw_breakpoint_used_count (); |
| target_resources_ok = |
| target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint, |
| i + 1, 0); |
| if (target_resources_ok == 0) |
| error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target.")); |
| else if (target_resources_ok < 0) |
| error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit.")); |
| } |
| |
| gdb_assert (!sals.empty ()); |
| |
| thread = thread_; |
| task = task_; |
| |
| cond_string = std::move (cond_string_); |
| extra_string = std::move (extra_string_); |
| ignore_count = ignore_count_; |
| enable_state = enabled_ ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled; |
| disposition = disposition_; |
| |
| if (type == bp_static_tracepoint |
| || type == bp_static_marker_tracepoint) |
| { |
| auto *t = static_cast<struct tracepoint *> (this); |
| struct static_tracepoint_marker marker; |
| |
| if (strace_marker_p (this)) |
| { |
| /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we wouldn't |
| see a sal for it. */ |
| const char *p = &event_location_to_string (location_.get ())[3]; |
| const char *endp; |
| |
| p = skip_spaces (p); |
| |
| endp = skip_to_space (p); |
| |
| t->static_trace_marker_id.assign (p, endp - p); |
| |
| gdb_printf (_("Probed static tracepoint marker \"%s\"\n"), |
| t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ()); |
| } |
| else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sals[0].pc, &marker)) |
| { |
| t->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id); |
| |
| gdb_printf (_("Probed static tracepoint marker \"%s\"\n"), |
| t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ()); |
| } |
| else |
| warning (_("Couldn't determine the static tracepoint marker to probe")); |
| } |
| |
| for (const auto &sal : sals) |
| { |
| if (from_tty) |
| { |
| struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal); |
| if (loc_gdbarch == nullptr) |
| loc_gdbarch = gdbarch; |
| |
| describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch, |
| sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread); |
| } |
| |
| bp_location *new_loc = add_location (sal); |
| if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0) |
| new_loc->inserted = 1; |
| |
| /* Do not set breakpoint locations conditions yet. As locations |
| are inserted, they get sorted based on their addresses. Let |
| the list stabilize to have reliable location numbers. */ |
| |
| /* Dynamic printf requires and uses additional arguments on the |
| command line, otherwise it's an error. */ |
| if (type == bp_dprintf) |
| { |
| if (extra_string != nullptr) |
| update_dprintf_command_list (this); |
| else |
| error (_("Format string required")); |
| } |
| else if (extra_string != nullptr) |
| error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of command"), extra_string.get ()); |
| } |
| |
| /* The order of the locations is now stable. Set the location |
| condition using the location's number. */ |
| int loc_num = 1; |
| for (bp_location *bl : locations ()) |
| { |
| if (cond_string != nullptr) |
| set_breakpoint_location_condition (cond_string.get (), bl, |
| number, loc_num); |
| |
| ++loc_num; |
| } |
| |
| display_canonical = display_canonical_; |
| if (location_ != nullptr) |
| location = std::move (location_); |
| else |
| location = new_address_location (this->loc->address, NULL, 0); |
| filter = std::move (filter_); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, |
| gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals, |
| event_location_up &&location, |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter, |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string, |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string, |
| enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition, |
| int thread, int task, int ignore_count, |
| int from_tty, |
| int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags, |
| int display_canonical) |
| { |
| std::unique_ptr<base_breakpoint> b |
| = new_breakpoint_from_type (gdbarch, |
| type, |
| sals, |
| std::move (location), |
| std::move (filter), |
| std::move (cond_string), |
| std::move (extra_string), |
| disposition, |
| thread, task, ignore_count, |
| from_tty, |
| enabled, flags, |
| display_canonical); |
| |
| install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0); |
| } |
| |
| /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each |
| SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i] |
| value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be |
| used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where |
| SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded |
| function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify |
| separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so |
| we take just a single condition string. |
| |
| NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup |
| the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the |
| array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the |
| caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, |
| COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */ |
| |
| static void |
| create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, |
| struct linespec_result *canonical, |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string, |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string, |
| enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition, |
| int thread, int task, int ignore_count, |
| int from_tty, |
| int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags) |
| { |
| if (canonical->pre_expanded) |
| gdb_assert (canonical->lsals.size () == 1); |
| |
| for (const auto &lsal : canonical->lsals) |
| { |
| /* Note that 'location' can be NULL in the case of a plain |
| 'break', without arguments. */ |
| event_location_up location |
| = (canonical->location != NULL |
| ? copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ()) : NULL); |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter_string |
| (lsal.canonical != NULL ? xstrdup (lsal.canonical) : NULL); |
| |
| create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, lsal.sals, |
| std::move (location), |
| std::move (filter_string), |
| std::move (cond_string), |
| std::move (extra_string), |
| type, disposition, |
| thread, task, ignore_count, |
| from_tty, enabled, internal, flags, |
| canonical->special_display); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Parse LOCATION which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly |
| followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL |
| addresses found. LOCATION points to the end of the SAL (for |
| linespec locations). |
| |
| The array and the line spec strings are allocated on the heap, it is |
| the caller's responsibility to free them. */ |
| |
| static void |
| parse_breakpoint_sals (struct event_location *location, |
| struct linespec_result *canonical) |
| { |
| struct symtab_and_line cursal; |
| |
| if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION) |
| { |
| const char *spec = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string; |
| |
| if (spec == NULL) |
| { |
| /* The last displayed codepoint, if it's valid, is our default |
| breakpoint address. */ |
| if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ()) |
| { |
| /* Set sal's pspace, pc, symtab, and line to the values |
| corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. |
| Be sure to reinitialize LINE with NOTCURRENT == 0 |
| as the breakpoint line number is inappropriate otherwise. |
| find_pc_line would adjust PC, re-set it back. */ |
| symtab_and_line sal = get_last_displayed_sal (); |
| CORE_ADDR pc = sal.pc; |
| |
| sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0); |
| |
| /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC" |
| where PC is the last displayed codepoint's address. So |
| make sure to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from |
| trying to expand the list of sals to include all other |
| instances with the same symtab and line. */ |
| sal.pc = pc; |
| sal.explicit_pc = 1; |
| |
| struct linespec_sals lsal; |
| lsal.sals = {sal}; |
| lsal.canonical = NULL; |
| |
| canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal)); |
| return; |
| } |
| else |
| error (_("No default breakpoint address now.")); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the |
| current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default). |
| This should produce the results we want almost all of the |
| time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone. |
| |
| ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which |
| may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '['. */ |
| cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line (); |
| if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ()) |
| { |
| const char *spec = NULL; |
| |
| if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION) |
| spec = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string; |
| |
| if (!cursal.symtab |
| || (spec != NULL |
| && strchr ("+-", spec[0]) != NULL |
| && spec[1] != '[')) |
| { |
| decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL, |
| get_last_displayed_symtab (), |
| get_last_displayed_line (), |
| canonical, NULL, NULL); |
| return; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL, |
| cursal.symtab, cursal.line, canonical, NULL, NULL); |
| } |
| |
| |
| /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be |
| inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */ |
| |
| static void |
| breakpoint_sals_to_pc (std::vector<symtab_and_line> &sals) |
| { |
| for (auto &sal : sals) |
| resolve_sal_pc (&sal); |
| } |
| |
| /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For |
| instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will |
| likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can |
| only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a |
| multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of |
| it, etc. */ |
| |
| static void |
| check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, |
| gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals) |
| { |
| for (const auto &sal : sals) |
| { |
| struct gdbarch *sarch; |
| |
| sarch = get_sal_arch (sal); |
| /* We fall back to GDBARCH if there is no architecture |
| associated with SAL. */ |
| if (sarch == NULL) |
| sarch = gdbarch; |
| std::string msg; |
| if (!gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (sarch, sal.pc, &msg)) |
| error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at %s%s"), |
| paddress (sarch, sal.pc), msg.c_str ()); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as |
| accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition |
| string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD. |
| PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed. |
| If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL. |
| If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */ |
| |
| static void |
| find_condition_and_thread (const char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc, |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> *cond_string, |
| int *thread, int *task, |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> *rest) |
| { |
| cond_string->reset (); |
| *thread = -1; |
| *task = 0; |
| rest->reset (); |
| bool force = false; |
| |
| while (tok && *tok) |
| { |
| const char *end_tok; |
| int toklen; |
| const char *cond_start = NULL; |
| const char *cond_end = NULL; |
| |
| tok = skip_spaces (tok); |
| |
| if ((*tok == '"' || *tok == ',') && rest) |
| { |
| rest->reset (savestring (tok, strlen (tok))); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| end_tok = skip_to_space (tok); |
| |
| toklen = end_tok - tok; |
| |
| if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0) |
| { |
| tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1; |
| try |
| { |
| parse_exp_1 (&tok, pc, block_for_pc (pc), 0); |
| } |
| catch (const gdb_exception_error &) |
| { |
| if (!force) |
| throw; |
| else |
| tok = tok + strlen (tok); |
| } |
| cond_end = tok; |
| cond_string->reset (savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start)); |
| } |
| else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "-force-condition", toklen) == 0) |
| { |
| tok = tok + toklen; |
| force = true; |
| } |
| else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0) |
| { |
| const char *tmptok; |
| struct thread_info *thr; |
| |
| tok = end_tok + 1; |
| thr = parse_thread_id (tok, &tmptok); |
| if (tok == tmptok) |
| error (_("Junk after thread keyword.")); |
| *thread = thr->global_num; |
| tok = tmptok; |
| } |
| else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0) |
| { |
| char *tmptok; |
| |
| tok = end_tok + 1; |
| *task = strtol (tok, &tmptok, 0); |
| if (tok == tmptok) |
| error (_("Junk after task keyword.")); |
| if (!valid_task_id (*task)) |
| error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task); |
| tok = tmptok; |
| } |
| else if (rest) |
| { |
| rest->reset (savestring (tok, strlen (tok))); |
| return; |
| } |
| else |
| error (_("Junk at end of arguments.")); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Call 'find_condition_and_thread' for each sal in SALS until a parse |
| succeeds. The parsed values are written to COND_STRING, THREAD, |
| TASK, and REST. See the comment of 'find_condition_and_thread' |
| for the description of these parameters and INPUT. */ |
| |
| static void |
| find_condition_and_thread_for_sals (const std::vector<symtab_and_line> &sals, |
| const char *input, |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> *cond_string, |
| int *thread, int *task, |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> *rest) |
| { |
| int num_failures = 0; |
| for (auto &sal : sals) |
| { |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond; |
| int thread_id = 0; |
| int task_id = 0; |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> remaining; |
| |
| /* Here we want to parse 'arg' to separate condition from thread |
| number. But because parsing happens in a context and the |
| contexts of sals might be different, try each until there is |
| success. Finding one successful parse is sufficient for our |
| goal. When setting the breakpoint we'll re-parse the |
| condition in the context of each sal. */ |
| try |
| { |
| find_condition_and_thread (input, sal.pc, &cond, &thread_id, |
| &task_id, &remaining); |
| *cond_string = std::move (cond); |
| *thread = thread_id; |
| *task = task_id; |
| *rest = std::move (remaining); |
| break; |
| } |
| catch (const gdb_exception_error &e) |
| { |
| num_failures++; |
| /* If no sal remains, do not continue. */ |
| if (num_failures == sals.size ()) |
| throw; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec. */ |
| |
| static std::vector<symtab_and_line> |
| decode_static_tracepoint_spec (const char **arg_p) |
| { |
| const char *p = &(*arg_p)[3]; |
| const char *endp; |
| |
| p = skip_spaces (p); |
| |
| endp = skip_to_space (p); |
| |
| std::string marker_str (p, endp - p); |
| |
| std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers |
| = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str.c_str ()); |
| if (markers.empty ()) |
| error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"), |
| marker_str.c_str ()); |
| |
| std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals; |
| sals.reserve (markers.size ()); |
| |
| for (const static_tracepoint_marker &marker : markers) |
| { |
| symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (marker.address, 0); |
| sal.pc = marker.address; |
| sals.push_back (sal); |
| } |
| |
| *arg_p = endp; |
| return sals; |
| } |
| |
| /* Returns the breakpoint ops appropriate for use with with LOCATION_TYPE and |
| according to IS_TRACEPOINT. */ |
| |
| static const struct breakpoint_ops * |
| breakpoint_ops_for_event_location_type (enum event_location_type location_type, |
| bool is_tracepoint) |
| { |
| if (is_tracepoint) |
| { |
| if (location_type == PROBE_LOCATION) |
| return &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops; |
| else |
| return &base_breakpoint_ops; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (location_type == PROBE_LOCATION) |
| return &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops; |
| else |
| return &base_breakpoint_ops; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| const struct breakpoint_ops * |
| breakpoint_ops_for_event_location (const struct event_location *location, |
| bool is_tracepoint) |
| { |
| if (location != nullptr) |
| return breakpoint_ops_for_event_location_type |
| (event_location_type (location), is_tracepoint); |
| return &base_breakpoint_ops; |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| int |
| create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, |
| struct event_location *location, |
| const char *cond_string, |
| int thread, const char *extra_string, |
| bool force_condition, int parse_extra, |
| int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted, |
| int ignore_count, |
| enum auto_boolean pending_break_support, |
| const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, |
| int from_tty, int enabled, int internal, |
| unsigned flags) |
| { |
| struct linespec_result canonical; |
| int pending = 0; |
| int task = 0; |
| int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count; |
| |
| gdb_assert (ops != NULL); |
| |
| /* If extra_string isn't useful, set it to NULL. */ |
| if (extra_string != NULL && *extra_string == '\0') |
| extra_string = NULL; |
| |
| try |
| { |
| ops->create_sals_from_location (location, &canonical); |
| } |
| catch (const gdb_exception_error &e) |
| { |
| /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set |
| value. */ |
| if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR) |
| { |
| /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw |
| error. */ |
| |
| if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE) |
| throw; |
| |
| exception_print (gdb_stderr, e); |
| |
| /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user |
| selects no, then simply return the error code. */ |
| if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO |
| && !nquery (_("Make %s pending on future shared library load? "), |
| bptype_string (type_wanted))) |
| return 0; |
| |
| /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting |
| a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending |
| breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint |
| is defaulted on behalf of the user. */ |
| pending = 1; |
| } |
| else |
| throw; |
| } |
| |
| if (!pending && canonical.lsals.empty ()) |
| return 0; |
| |
| /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses |
| are ok for the target. */ |
| if (!pending) |
| { |
| for (auto &lsal : canonical.lsals) |
| breakpoint_sals_to_pc (lsal.sals); |
| } |
| |
| /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */ |
| if (!pending && type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint) |
| { |
| for (const auto &lsal : canonical.lsals) |
| check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, lsal.sals); |
| } |
| |
| /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any |
| breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each |
| breakpoint. */ |
| if (!pending) |
| { |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string_copy; |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string_copy; |
| |
| if (parse_extra) |
| { |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> rest; |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond; |
| |
| const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0]; |
| |
| find_condition_and_thread_for_sals (lsal.sals, extra_string, |
| &cond, &thread, &task, &rest); |
| cond_string_copy = std::move (cond); |
| extra_string_copy = std::move (rest); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (type_wanted != bp_dprintf |
| && extra_string != NULL && *extra_string != '\0') |
| error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of location"), extra_string); |
| |
| /* Check the validity of the condition. We should error out |
| if the condition is invalid at all of the locations and |
| if it is not forced. In the PARSE_EXTRA case above, this |
| check is done when parsing the EXTRA_STRING. */ |
| if (cond_string != nullptr && !force_condition) |
| { |
| int num_failures = 0; |
| const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0]; |
| for (const auto &sal : lsal.sals) |
| { |
| const char *cond = cond_string; |
| try |
| { |
| parse_exp_1 (&cond, sal.pc, block_for_pc (sal.pc), 0); |
| /* One success is sufficient to keep going. */ |
| break; |
| } |
| catch (const gdb_exception_error &) |
| { |
| num_failures++; |
| /* If this is the last sal, error out. */ |
| if (num_failures == lsal.sals.size ()) |
| throw; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Create a private copy of condition string. */ |
| if (cond_string) |
| cond_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (cond_string)); |
| /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */ |
| if (extra_string) |
| extra_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (extra_string)); |
| } |
| |
| ops->create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, &canonical, |
| std::move (cond_string_copy), |
| std::move (extra_string_copy), |
| type_wanted, |
| tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch, |
| thread, task, ignore_count, |
| from_tty, enabled, internal, flags); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| std::unique_ptr <breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (gdbarch, |
| type_wanted); |
| b->location = copy_event_location (location); |
| |
| if (parse_extra) |
| b->cond_string = NULL; |
| else |
| { |
| /* Create a private copy of condition string. */ |
| b->cond_string.reset (cond_string != NULL |
| ? xstrdup (cond_string) |
| : NULL); |
| b->thread = thread; |
| } |
| |
| /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */ |
| b->extra_string.reset (extra_string != NULL |
| ? xstrdup (extra_string) |
| : NULL); |
| b->ignore_count = ignore_count; |
| b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch; |
| b->condition_not_parsed = 1; |
| b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled; |
| if ((type_wanted != bp_breakpoint |
| && type_wanted != bp_hardware_breakpoint) || thread != -1) |
| b->pspace = current_program_space; |
| |
| install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0); |
| } |
| |
| if (canonical.lsals.size () > 1) |
| { |
| warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\nUse the " |
| "\"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints.")); |
| prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count; |
| } |
| |
| update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); |
| |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| /* Set a breakpoint. |
| ARG is a string describing breakpoint address, |
| condition, and thread. |
| FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on, |
| and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG |
| and BP_TEMPFLAG. */ |
| |
| static void |
| break_command_1 (const char *arg, int flag, int from_tty) |
| { |
| int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG; |
| enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG |
| ? bp_hardware_breakpoint |
| : bp_breakpoint); |
| |
| event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language); |
| const struct breakpoint_ops *ops = breakpoint_ops_for_event_location |
| (location.get (), false /* is_tracepoint */); |
| |
| create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), |
| location.get (), |
| NULL, 0, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */, |
| tempflag, type_wanted, |
| 0 /* Ignore count */, |
| pending_break_support, |
| ops, |
| from_tty, |
| 1 /* enabled */, |
| 0 /* internal */, |
| 0); |
| } |
| |
| /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */ |
| |
| void |
| resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal) |
| { |
| CORE_ADDR pc; |
| |
| if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL) |
| { |
| if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc)) |
| error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."), |
| sal->line, symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal->symtab)); |
| sal->pc = pc; |
| |
| /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line |
| number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */ |
| if (sal->explicit_line) |
| skip_prologue_sal (sal); |
| } |
| |
| if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL) |
| { |
| const struct blockvector *bv; |
| const struct block *b; |
| struct symbol *sym; |
| |
| bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b, |
| sal->symtab->compunit ()); |
| if (bv != NULL) |
| { |
| sym = block_linkage_function (b); |
| if (sym != NULL) |
| { |
| fixup_symbol_section (sym, sal->symtab->compunit ()->objfile ()); |
| sal->section |
| = sym->obj_section (sal->symtab->compunit ()->objfile ()); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll |
| just have to look harder. This case can be executed |
| if we have line numbers but no functions (as can |
| happen in assembly source). */ |
| |
| scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread; |
| switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace); |
| |
| bound_minimal_symbol msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc); |
| if (msym.minsym) |
| sal->section = msym.obj_section (); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| void |
| break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) |
| { |
| break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| tbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) |
| { |
| break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| hbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) |
| { |
| break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| thbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) |
| { |
| break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty); |
| } |
| |
| /* The dynamic printf command is mostly like a regular breakpoint, but |
| with a prewired command list consisting of a single output command, |
| built from extra arguments supplied on the dprintf command |
| line. */ |
| |
| static void |
| dprintf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) |
| { |
| event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language); |
| |
| /* If non-NULL, ARG should have been advanced past the location; |
| the next character must be ','. */ |
| if (arg != NULL) |
| { |
| if (arg[0] != ',' || arg[1] == '\0') |
| error (_("Format string required")); |
| else |
| { |
| /* Skip the comma. */ |
| ++arg; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), |
| location.get (), |
| NULL, 0, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */, |
| 0, bp_dprintf, |
| 0 /* Ignore count */, |
| pending_break_support, |
| &base_breakpoint_ops, |
| from_tty, |
| 1 /* enabled */, |
| 0 /* internal */, |
| 0); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| agent_printf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) |
| { |
| error (_("May only run agent-printf on the target")); |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" method for ranged breakpoints. */ |
| |
| int |
| ranged_breakpoint::breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, |
| const address_space *aspace, |
| CORE_ADDR bp_addr, |
| const target_waitstatus &ws) |
| { |
| if (ws.kind () != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED |
| || ws.sig () != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP) |
| return 0; |
| |
| return breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address, |
| bl->length, aspace, bp_addr); |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement the "resources_needed" method for ranged breakpoints. */ |
| |
| int |
| ranged_breakpoint::resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl) |
| { |
| return target_ranged_break_num_registers (); |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement the "print_it" method for ranged breakpoints. */ |
| |
| enum print_stop_action |
| ranged_breakpoint::print_it (const bpstat *bs) const |
| { |
| struct bp_location *bl = loc; |
| struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; |
| |
| gdb_assert (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint); |
| |
| /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */ |
| gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL); |
| |
| annotate_breakpoint (number); |
| |
| maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout); |
| |
| if (disposition == disp_del) |
| uiout->text ("Temporary ranged breakpoint "); |
| else |
| uiout->text ("Ranged breakpoint "); |
| if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) |
| { |
| uiout->field_string ("reason", |
| async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT)); |
| uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (disposition)); |
| } |
| uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", number); |
| uiout->text (", "); |
| |
| return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC; |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement the "print_one" method for ranged breakpoints. */ |
| |
| bool |
| ranged_breakpoint::print_one (bp_location **last_loc) const |
| { |
| struct bp_location *bl = loc; |
| struct value_print_options opts; |
| struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; |
| |
| /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */ |
| gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL); |
| |
| get_user_print_options (&opts); |
| |
| if (opts.addressprint) |
| /* We don't print the address range here, it will be printed later |
| by print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint. */ |
| uiout->field_skip ("addr"); |
| annotate_field (5); |
| print_breakpoint_location (this, bl); |
| *last_loc = bl; |
| |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement the "print_one_detail" method for ranged breakpoints. */ |
| |
| void |
| ranged_breakpoint::print_one_detail (struct ui_out *uiout) const |
| { |
| CORE_ADDR address_start, address_end; |
| struct bp_location *bl = loc; |
| string_file stb; |
| |
| gdb_assert (bl); |
| |
| address_start = bl->address; |
| address_end = address_start + bl->length - 1; |
| |
| uiout->text ("\taddress range: "); |
| stb.printf ("[%s, %s]", |
| print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_start), |
| print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_end)); |
| uiout->field_stream ("addr", stb); |
| uiout->text ("\n"); |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement the "print_mention" method for ranged breakpoints. */ |
| |
| void |
| ranged_breakpoint::print_mention () const |
| { |
| struct bp_location *bl = loc; |
| struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; |
| |
| gdb_assert (bl); |
| gdb_assert (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint); |
| |
| uiout->message (_("Hardware assisted ranged breakpoint %d from %s to %s."), |
| number, paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address), |
| paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address + bl->length - 1)); |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement the "print_recreate" method for ranged breakpoints. */ |
| |
| void |
| ranged_breakpoint::print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const |
| { |
| gdb_printf (fp, "break-range %s, %s", |
| event_location_to_string (location.get ()), |
| event_location_to_string (location_range_end.get ())); |
| print_recreate_thread (fp); |
| } |
| |
| /* Find the address where the end of the breakpoint range should be |
| placed, given the SAL of the end of the range. This is so that if |
| the user provides a line number, the end of the range is set to the |
| last instruction of the given line. */ |
| |
| static CORE_ADDR |
| find_breakpoint_range_end (struct symtab_and_line sal) |
| { |
| CORE_ADDR end; |
| |
| /* If the user provided a PC value, use it. Otherwise, |
| find the address of the end of the given location. */ |
| if (sal.explicit_pc) |
| end = sal.pc; |
| else |
| { |
| int ret; |
| CORE_ADDR start; |
| |
| ret = find_line_pc_range (sal, &start, &end); |
| if (!ret) |
| error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range.")); |
| |
| /* find_line_pc_range returns the start of the next line. */ |
| end--; |
| } |
| |
| return end; |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement the "break-range" CLI command. */ |
| |
| static void |
| break_range_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) |
| { |
| const char *arg_start; |
| struct linespec_result canonical_start, canonical_end; |
| int bp_count, can_use_bp, length; |
| CORE_ADDR end; |
| |
| /* We don't support software ranged breakpoints. */ |
| if (target_ranged_break_num_registers () < 0) |
| error (_("This target does not support hardware ranged breakpoints.")); |
| |
| bp_count = hw_breakpoint_used_count (); |
| bp_count += target_ranged_break_num_registers (); |
| can_use_bp = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint, |
| bp_count, 0); |
| if (can_use_bp < 0) |
| error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit.")); |
| |
| arg = skip_spaces (arg); |
| if (arg == NULL || arg[0] == '\0') |
| error(_("No address range specified.")); |
| |
| arg_start = arg; |
| event_location_up start_location = string_to_event_location (&arg, |
| current_language); |
| parse_breakpoint_sals (start_location.get (), &canonical_start); |
| |
| if (arg[0] != ',') |
| error (_("Too few arguments.")); |
| else if (canonical_start.lsals.empty ()) |
| error (_("Could not find location of the beginning of the range.")); |
| |
| const linespec_sals &lsal_start = canonical_start.lsals[0]; |
| |
| if (canonical_start.lsals.size () > 1 |
| || lsal_start.sals.size () != 1) |
| error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations.")); |
| |
| const symtab_and_line &sal_start = lsal_start.sals[0]; |
| std::string addr_string_start (arg_start, arg - arg_start); |
| |
| arg++; /* Skip the comma. */ |
| arg = skip_spaces (arg); |
| |
| /* Parse the end location. */ |
| |
| arg_start = arg; |
| |
| /* We call decode_line_full directly here instead of using |
| parse_breakpoint_sals because we need to specify the start location's |
| symtab and line as the default symtab and line for the end of the |
| range. This makes it possible to have ranges like "foo.c:27, +14", |
| where +14 means 14 lines from the start location. */ |
| event_location_up end_location = string_to_event_location (&arg, |
| current_language); |
| decode_line_full (end_location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL, |
| sal_start.symtab, sal_start.line, |
| &canonical_end, NULL, NULL); |
| |
| if (canonical_end.lsals.empty ()) |
| error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range.")); |
| |
| const linespec_sals &lsal_end = canonical_end.lsals[0]; |
| if (canonical_end.lsals.size () > 1 |
| || lsal_end.sals.size () != 1) |
| error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations.")); |
| |
| const symtab_and_line &sal_end = lsal_end.sals[0]; |
| |
| end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sal_end); |
| if (sal_start.pc > end) |
| error (_("Invalid address range, end precedes start.")); |
| |
| length = end - sal_start.pc + 1; |
| if (length < 0) |
| /* Length overflowed. */ |
| error (_("Address range too large.")); |
| else if (length == 1) |
| { |
| /* This range is simple enough to be handled by |
| the `hbreak' command. */ |
| hbreak_command (&addr_string_start[0], 1); |
| |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| /* Now set up the breakpoint and install it. */ |
| |
| std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> br |
| (new ranged_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), |
| sal_start, length, |
| std::move (start_location), |
| std::move (end_location))); |
| |
| install_breakpoint (false, std::move (br), true); |
| } |
| |
| /* Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant. Returned zero |
| means EXP is variable. Also the constant detection may fail for |
| some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return |
| zero. */ |
| |
| static bool |
| watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp) |
| { |
| return exp->op->constant_p (); |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement the "re_set" method for watchpoints. */ |
| |
| void |
| watchpoint::re_set () |
| { |
| /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global |
| variables, or it can be on local variables. |
| |
| Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even |
| persist across program restarts. Since they can use variables |
| from shared libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries |
| are loaded and unloaded. |
| |
| Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result |
| of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local |
| and a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint, |
| but unloading of a shared library will make the expression |
| invalid. This is not a very common use case, but we still |
| re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to the user. |
| |
| Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if |
| watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means the |
| watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact, |
| I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case. |
| |
| If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then |
| exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it. |
| |
| Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will be |
| reevaluated again when enabled. */ |
| update_watchpoint (this, 1 /* reparse */); |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement the "insert" method for hardware watchpoints. */ |
| |
| int |
| watchpoint::insert_location (struct bp_location *bl) |
| { |
| int length = exact ? 1 : bl->length; |
| |
| return target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type, |
| cond_exp.get ()); |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement the "remove" method for hardware watchpoints. */ |
| |
| int |
| watchpoint::remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, |
| enum remove_bp_reason reason) |
| { |
| int length = exact ? 1 : bl->length; |
| |
| return target_remove_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type, |
| cond_exp.get ()); |
| } |
| |
| int |
| watchpoint::breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, |
| const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr, |
| const target_waitstatus &ws) |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner; |
| |
| /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the |
| reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on |
| some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction |
| in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has |
| been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger |
| (did not match the data address). */ |
| if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b) |
| && watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no) |
| return 0; |
| |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| watchpoint::check_status (bpstat *bs) |
| { |
| gdb_assert (is_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at)); |
| |
| bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs); |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement the "resources_needed" method for hardware |
| watchpoints. */ |
| |
| int |
| watchpoint::resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl) |
| { |
| int length = exact? 1 : bl->length; |
| |
| return target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (bl->address, length); |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" method for hardware |
| watchpoints. */ |
| |
| bool |
| watchpoint::works_in_software_mode () const |
| { |
| /* Read and access watchpoints only work with hardware support. */ |
| return type == bp_watchpoint || type == bp_hardware_watchpoint; |
| } |
| |
| enum print_stop_action |
| watchpoint::print_it (const bpstat *bs) const |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *b; |
| enum print_stop_action result; |
| struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; |
| |
| gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL); |
| |
| b = bs->breakpoint_at; |
| |
| annotate_watchpoint (b->number); |
| maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout); |
| |
| string_file stb; |
| |
| gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> tuple_emitter; |
| switch (b->type) |
| { |
| case bp_watchpoint: |
| case bp_hardware_watchpoint: |
| if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) |
| uiout->field_string |
| ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); |
| mention (b); |
| tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value"); |
| uiout->text ("\nOld value = "); |
| watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb); |
| uiout->field_stream ("old", stb); |
| uiout->text ("\nNew value = "); |
| watchpoint_value_print (val.get (), &stb); |
| uiout->field_stream ("new", stb); |
| uiout->text ("\n"); |
| /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */ |
| result = PRINT_UNKNOWN; |
| break; |
| |
| case bp_read_watchpoint: |
| if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) |
| uiout->field_string |
| ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); |
| mention (b); |
| tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value"); |
| uiout->text ("\nValue = "); |
| watchpoint_value_print (val.get (), &stb); |
| uiout->field_stream ("value", stb); |
| uiout->text ("\n"); |
| result = PRINT_UNKNOWN; |
| break; |
| |
| case bp_access_watchpoint: |
| if (bs->old_val != NULL) |
| { |
| if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) |
| uiout->field_string |
| ("reason", |
| async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); |
| mention (b); |
| tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value"); |
| uiout->text ("\nOld value = "); |
| watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb); |
| uiout->field_stream ("old", stb); |
| uiout->text ("\nNew value = "); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| mention (b); |
| if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) |
| uiout->field_string |
| ("reason", |
| async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); |
| tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value"); |
| uiout->text ("\nValue = "); |
| } |
| watchpoint_value_print (val.get (), &stb); |
| uiout->field_stream ("new", stb); |
| uiout->text ("\n"); |
| result = PRINT_UNKNOWN; |
| break; |
| default: |
| result = PRINT_UNKNOWN; |
| } |
| |
| return result; |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement the "print_mention" method for hardware watchpoints. */ |
| |
| void |
| watchpoint::print_mention () const |
| { |
| struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; |
| const char *tuple_name; |
| |
| switch (type) |
| { |
| case bp_watchpoint: |
| uiout->text ("Watchpoint "); |
| tuple_name = "wpt"; |
| break; |
| case bp_hardware_watchpoint: |
| uiout->text ("Hardware watchpoint "); |
| tuple_name = "wpt"; |
| break; |
| case bp_read_watchpoint: |
| uiout->text ("Hardware read watchpoint "); |
| tuple_name = "hw-rwpt"; |
| break; |
| case bp_access_watchpoint: |
| uiout->text ("Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint "); |
| tuple_name = "hw-awpt"; |
| break; |
| default: |
| internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, |
| _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type.")); |
| } |
| |
| ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name); |
| uiout->field_signed ("number", number); |
| uiout->text (": "); |
| uiout->field_string ("exp", exp_string.get ()); |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement the "print_recreate" method for watchpoints. */ |
| |
| void |
| watchpoint::print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const |
| { |
| switch (type) |
| { |
| case bp_watchpoint: |
| case bp_hardware_watchpoint: |
| gdb_printf (fp, "watch"); |
| break; |
| case bp_read_watchpoint: |
| gdb_printf (fp, "rwatch"); |
| break; |
| case bp_access_watchpoint: |
| gdb_printf (fp, "awatch"); |
| break; |
| default: |
| internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, |
| _("Invalid watchpoint type.")); |
| } |
| |
| gdb_printf (fp, " %s", exp_string.get ()); |
| print_recreate_thread (fp); |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement the "explains_signal" method for watchpoints. */ |
| |
| bool |
| watchpoint::explains_signal (enum gdb_signal sig) |
| { |
| /* A software watchpoint cannot cause a signal other than |
| GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */ |
| if (type == bp_watchpoint && sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP) |
| return false; |
| |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| struct masked_watchpoint : public watchpoint |
| { |
| using watchpoint::watchpoint; |
| |
| int insert_location (struct bp_location *) override; |
| int remove_location (struct bp_location *, |
| enum remove_bp_reason reason) override; |
| int resources_needed (const struct bp_location *) override; |
| bool works_in_software_mode () const override; |
| enum print_stop_action print_it (const bpstat *bs) const override; |
| void print_one_detail (struct ui_out *) const override; |
| void print_mention () const override; |
| void print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const override; |
| }; |
| |
| /* Implement the "insert" method for masked hardware watchpoints. */ |
| |
| int |
| masked_watchpoint::insert_location (struct bp_location *bl) |
| { |
| return target_insert_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, hw_wp_mask, |
| bl->watchpoint_type); |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement the "remove" method for masked hardware watchpoints. */ |
| |
| int |
| masked_watchpoint::remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, |
| enum remove_bp_reason reason) |
| { |
| return target_remove_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, hw_wp_mask, |
| bl->watchpoint_type); |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement the "resources_needed" method for masked hardware |
| watchpoints. */ |
| |
| int |
| masked_watchpoint::resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl) |
| { |
| return target_masked_watch_num_registers (bl->address, hw_wp_mask); |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" method for masked hardware |
| watchpoints. */ |
| |
| bool |
| masked_watchpoint::works_in_software_mode () const |
| { |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement the "print_it" method for masked hardware |
| watchpoints. */ |
| |
| enum print_stop_action |
| masked_watchpoint::print_it (const bpstat *bs) const |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at; |
| struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; |
| |
| /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */ |
| gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL); |
| |
| annotate_watchpoint (b->number); |
| maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout); |
| |
| switch (b->type) |
| { |
| case bp_hardware_watchpoint: |
| if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) |
| uiout->field_string |
| ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); |
| break; |
| |
| case bp_read_watchpoint: |
| if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) |
| uiout->field_string |
| ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); |
| break; |
| |
| case bp_access_watchpoint: |
| if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) |
| uiout->field_string |
| ("reason", |
| async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); |
| break; |
| default: |
| internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, |
| _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type.")); |
| } |
| |
| mention (b); |
| uiout->text (_("\n\ |
| Check the underlying instruction at PC for the memory\n\ |
| address and value which triggered this watchpoint.\n")); |
| uiout->text ("\n"); |
| |
| /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */ |
| return PRINT_UNKNOWN; |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement the "print_one_detail" method for masked hardware |
| watchpoints. */ |
| |
| void |
| masked_watchpoint::print_one_detail (struct ui_out *uiout) const |
| { |
| /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */ |
| gdb_assert (loc && loc->next == NULL); |
| |
| uiout->text ("\tmask "); |
| uiout->field_core_addr ("mask", loc->gdbarch, hw_wp_mask); |
| uiout->text ("\n"); |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement the "print_mention" method for masked hardware |
| watchpoints. */ |
| |
| void |
| masked_watchpoint::print_mention () const |
| { |
| struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; |
| const char *tuple_name; |
| |
| switch (type) |
| { |
| case bp_hardware_watchpoint: |
| uiout->text ("Masked hardware watchpoint "); |
| tuple_name = "wpt"; |
| break; |
| case bp_read_watchpoint: |
| uiout->text ("Masked hardware read watchpoint "); |
| tuple_name = "hw-rwpt"; |
| break; |
| case bp_access_watchpoint: |
| uiout->text ("Masked hardware access (read/write) watchpoint "); |
| tuple_name = "hw-awpt"; |
| break; |
| default: |
| internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, |
| _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type.")); |
| } |
| |
| ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name); |
| uiout->field_signed ("number", number); |
| uiout->text (": "); |
| uiout->field_string ("exp", exp_string.get ()); |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement the "print_recreate" method for masked hardware |
| watchpoints. */ |
| |
| void |
| masked_watchpoint::print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const |
| { |
| switch (type) |
| { |
| case bp_hardware_watchpoint: |
| gdb_printf (fp, "watch"); |
| break; |
| case bp_read_watchpoint: |
| gdb_printf (fp, "rwatch"); |
| break; |
| case bp_access_watchpoint: |
| gdb_printf (fp, "awatch"); |
| break; |
| default: |
| internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, |
| _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type.")); |
| } |
| |
| gdb_printf (fp, " %s mask 0x%s", exp_string.get (), |
| phex (hw_wp_mask, sizeof (CORE_ADDR))); |
| print_recreate_thread (fp); |
| } |
| |
| /* Tell whether the given watchpoint is a masked hardware watchpoint. */ |
| |
| static bool |
| is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| return dynamic_cast<const masked_watchpoint *> (b) != nullptr; |
| } |
| |
| /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write, |
| hw_read: watch read, |
| hw_access: watch access (read or write) */ |
| static void |
| watch_command_1 (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty, |
| bool just_location, bool internal) |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *scope_breakpoint = NULL; |
| const struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL; |
| struct value *result; |
| int saved_bitpos = 0, saved_bitsize = 0; |
| const char *exp_start = NULL; |
| const char *exp_end = NULL; |
| const char *tok, *end_tok; |
| int toklen = -1; |
| const char *cond_start = NULL; |
| const char *cond_end = NULL; |
| enum bptype bp_type; |
| int thread = -1; |
| /* Flag to indicate whether we are going to use masks for |
| the hardware watchpoint. */ |
| bool use_mask = false; |
| CORE_ADDR mask = 0; |
| int task = 0; |
| |
| /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */ |
| if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0') |
| { |
| const char *value_start; |
| |
| exp_end = arg + strlen (arg); |
| |
| /* Look for "parameter value" pairs at the end |
| of the arguments string. */ |
| for (tok = exp_end - 1; tok > arg; tok--) |
| { |
| /* Skip whitespace at the end of the argument list. */ |
| while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')) |
| tok--; |
| |
| /* Find the beginning of the last token. |
| This is the value of the parameter. */ |
| while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t')) |
| tok--; |
| value_start = tok + 1; |
| |
| /* Skip whitespace. */ |
| while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')) |
| tok--; |
| |
| end_tok = tok; |
| |
| /* Find the beginning of the second to last token. |
| This is the parameter itself. */ |
| while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t')) |
| tok--; |
| tok++; |
| toklen = end_tok - tok + 1; |
| |
| if (toklen == 6 && startswith (tok, "thread")) |
| { |
| struct thread_info *thr; |
| /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means |
| the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers |
| only in a specific thread. */ |
| const char *endp; |
| |
| if (thread != -1) |
| error(_("You can specify only one thread.")); |
| |
| /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */ |
| thr = parse_thread_id (value_start, &endp); |
| |
| /* Check if the user provided a valid thread ID. */ |
| if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0') |
| invalid_thread_id_error (value_start); |
| |
| thread = thr->global_num; |
| } |
| else if (toklen == 4 && startswith (tok, "task")) |
| { |
| char *tmp; |
| |
| task = strtol (value_start, &tmp, 0); |
| if (tmp == value_start) |
| error (_("Junk after task keyword.")); |
| if (!valid_task_id (task)) |
| error (_("Unknown task %d."), task); |
| } |
| else if (toklen == 4 && startswith (tok, "mask")) |
| { |
| /* We've found a "mask" token, which means the user wants to |
| create a hardware watchpoint that is going to have the mask |
| facility. */ |
| struct value *mask_value, *mark; |
| |
| if (use_mask) |
| error(_("You can specify only one mask.")); |
| |
| use_mask = just_location = true; |
| |
| mark = value_mark (); |
| mask_value = parse_to_comma_and_eval (&value_start); |
| mask = value_as_address (mask_value); |
| value_free_to_mark (mark); |
| } |
| else |
| /* We didn't recognize what we found. We should stop here. */ |
| break; |
| |
| /* Truncate the string and get rid of the "parameter value" pair before |
| the arguments string is parsed by the parse_exp_1 function. */ |
| exp_end = tok; |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| exp_end = arg; |
| |
| /* Parse the rest of the arguments. From here on out, everything |
| is in terms of a newly allocated string instead of the original |
| ARG. */ |
| std::string expression (arg, exp_end - arg); |
| exp_start = arg = expression.c_str (); |
| innermost_block_tracker tracker; |
| expression_up exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0, &tracker); |
| exp_end = arg; |
| /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it. |
| This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit |
| prettier. */ |
| while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t')) |
| --exp_end; |
| |
| /* Checking if the expression is not constant. */ |
| if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp.get ())) |
| { |
| int len; |
| |
| len = exp_end - exp_start; |
| while (len > 0 && isspace (exp_start[len - 1])) |
| len--; |
| error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start); |
| } |
| |
| exp_valid_block = tracker.block (); |
| struct value *mark = value_mark (); |
| struct value *val_as_value = nullptr; |
| fetch_subexp_value (exp.get (), exp->op.get (), &val_as_value, &result, NULL, |
| just_location); |
| |
| if (val_as_value != NULL && just_location) |
| { |
| saved_bitpos = value_bitpos (val_as_value); |
| saved_bitsize = value_bitsize (val_as_value); |
| } |
| |
| value_ref_ptr val; |
| if (just_location) |
| { |
| int ret; |
| |
| exp_valid_block = NULL; |
| val = release_value (value_addr (result)); |
| value_free_to_mark (mark); |
| |
| if (use_mask) |
| { |
| ret = target_masked_watch_num_registers (value_as_address (val.get ()), |
| mask); |
| if (ret == -1) |
| error (_("This target does not support masked watchpoints.")); |
| else if (ret == -2) |
| error (_("Invalid mask or memory region.")); |
| } |
| } |
| else if (val_as_value != NULL) |
| val = release_value (val_as_value); |
| |
| tok = skip_spaces (arg); |
| end_tok = skip_to_space (tok); |
| |
| toklen = end_tok - tok; |
| if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0) |
| { |
| tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1; |
| innermost_block_tracker if_tracker; |
| parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0, 0, &if_tracker); |
| |
| /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition |
| may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */ |
| cond_exp_valid_block = if_tracker.block (); |
| |
| cond_end = tok; |
| } |
| if (*tok) |
| error (_("Junk at end of command.")); |
| |
| frame_info *wp_frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block); |
| |
| /* Save this because create_internal_breakpoint below invalidates |
| 'wp_frame'. */ |
| frame_id watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (wp_frame); |
| |
| /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope" |
| breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint |
| expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so |
| that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */ |
| if (exp_valid_block != NULL && wp_frame != NULL) |
| { |
| frame_id caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (wp_frame); |
| |
| if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id)) |
| { |
| gdbarch *caller_arch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (wp_frame); |
| CORE_ADDR caller_pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (wp_frame); |
| |
| scope_breakpoint |
| = create_internal_breakpoint (caller_arch, caller_pc, |
| bp_watchpoint_scope); |
| |
| /* create_internal_breakpoint could invalidate WP_FRAME. */ |
| wp_frame = NULL; |
| |
| scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled; |
| |
| /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */ |
| scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del; |
| |
| /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */ |
| scope_breakpoint->frame_id = caller_frame_id; |
| |
| /* Set the address at which we will stop. */ |
| scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch = caller_arch; |
| scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address = caller_pc; |
| scope_breakpoint->loc->address |
| = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch, |
| scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address, |
| scope_breakpoint->type); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Now set up the breakpoint. We create all watchpoints as hardware |
| watchpoints here even if hardware watchpoints are turned off, a call |
| to update_watchpoint later in this function will cause the type to |
| drop back to bp_watchpoint (software watchpoint) if required. */ |
| |
| if (accessflag == hw_read) |
| bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint; |
| else if (accessflag == hw_access) |
| bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint; |
| else |
| bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint; |
| |
| std::unique_ptr<watchpoint> w; |
| if (use_mask) |
| w.reset (new masked_watchpoint (nullptr, bp_type)); |
| else |
| w.reset (new watchpoint (nullptr, bp_type)); |
| |
| w->thread = thread; |
| w->task = task; |
| w->disposition = disp_donttouch; |
| w->pspace = current_program_space; |
| w->exp = std::move (exp); |
| w->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block; |
| w->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block; |
| if (just_location) |
| { |
| struct type *t = value_type (val.get ()); |
| CORE_ADDR addr = value_as_address (val.get ()); |
| |
| w->exp_string_reparse |
| = current_language->watch_location_expression (t, addr); |
| |
| w->exp_string = xstrprintf ("-location %.*s", |
| (int) (exp_end - exp_start), exp_start); |
| } |
| else |
| w->exp_string.reset (savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start)); |
| |
| if (use_mask) |
| { |
| w->hw_wp_mask = mask; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| w->val = val; |
| w->val_bitpos = saved_bitpos; |
| w->val_bitsize = saved_bitsize; |
| w->val_valid = true; |
| } |
| |
| if (cond_start) |
| w->cond_string.reset (savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start)); |
| else |
| w->cond_string = 0; |
| |
| if (frame_id_p (watchpoint_frame)) |
| { |
| w->watchpoint_frame = watchpoint_frame; |
| w->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| w->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id; |
| w->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid; |
| } |
| |
| if (scope_breakpoint != NULL) |
| { |
| /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will |
| need to act on them together. */ |
| w->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint; |
| scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w.get (); |
| } |
| |
| if (!just_location) |
| value_free_to_mark (mark); |
| |
| /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations |
| that should be inserted. */ |
| update_watchpoint (w.get (), 1); |
| |
| install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (w), 1); |
| } |
| |
| /* Return count of debug registers needed to watch the given expression. |
| If the watchpoint cannot be handled in hardware return zero. */ |
| |
| static int |
| can_use_hardware_watchpoint (const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals) |
| { |
| int found_memory_cnt = 0; |
| |
| /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */ |
| if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints) |
| return 0; |
| |
| gdb_assert (!vals.empty ()); |
| struct value *head = vals[0].get (); |
| |
| /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon |
| memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we |
| find any register references or function calls, we can't use a |
| hardware watchpoint. |
| |
| The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series |
| of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The |
| expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and |
| a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish |
| the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues, |
| register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate |
| the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves |
| behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the |
| expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints. |
| |
| However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior |
| function calls are special in any way. So this function may not |
| notice that an expression involving an inferior function call |
| can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */ |
| for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : vals) |
| { |
| struct value *v = iter.get (); |
| |
| if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory) |
| { |
| if (v != head && value_lazy (v)) |
| /* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never |
| needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g., |
| `a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a' |
| in `a,b'). This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is |
| lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway. */ |
| ; |
| else |
| { |
| /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover |
| it with hardware watchpoints. */ |
| struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v)); |
| |
| /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it |
| explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a |
| middle of some value chain. */ |
| if (v == head |
| || (vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT |
| && vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)) |
| { |
| CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v); |
| int len; |
| int num_regs; |
| |
| len = (target_exact_watchpoints |
| && is_scalar_type_recursive (vtype))? |
| 1 : TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v)); |
| |
| num_regs = target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len); |
| if (!num_regs) |
| return 0; |
| else |
| found_memory_cnt += num_regs; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval |
| && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0) |
| return 0; /* These are values from the history (e.g., $1). */ |
| else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register) |
| return 0; /* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint. */ |
| } |
| |
| /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware |
| watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */ |
| return found_memory_cnt; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| watch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, bool internal) |
| { |
| watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty, 0, internal); |
| } |
| |
| /* Options for the watch, awatch, and rwatch commands. */ |
| |
| struct watch_options |
| { |
| /* For -location. */ |
| bool location = false; |
| }; |
| |
| /* Definitions of options for the "watch", "awatch", and "rwatch" commands. |
| |
| Historically GDB always accepted both '-location' and '-l' flags for |
| these commands (both flags being synonyms). When converting to the |
| newer option scheme only '-location' is added here. That's fine (for |
| backward compatibility) as any non-ambiguous prefix of a flag will be |
| accepted, so '-l', '-loc', are now all accepted. |
| |
| What this means is that, if in the future, we add any new flag here |
| that starts with '-l' then this will break backward compatibility, so |
| please, don't do that! */ |
| |
| static const gdb::option::option_def watch_option_defs[] = { |
| gdb::option::flag_option_def<watch_options> { |
| "location", |
| [] (watch_options *opt) { return &opt->location; }, |
| N_("\ |
| This evaluates EXPRESSION and watches the memory to which is refers.\n\ |
| -l can be used as a short form of -location."), |
| }, |
| }; |
| |
| /* Returns the option group used by 'watch', 'awatch', and 'rwatch' |
| commands. */ |
| |
| static gdb::option::option_def_group |
| make_watch_options_def_group (watch_options *opts) |
| { |
| return {{watch_option_defs}, opts}; |
| } |
| |
| /* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then |
| calls watch_command_1. */ |
| |
| static void |
| watch_maybe_just_location (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty) |
| { |
| watch_options opts; |
| auto grp = make_watch_options_def_group (&opts); |
| gdb::option::process_options |
| (&arg, gdb::option::PROCESS_OPTIONS_UNKNOWN_IS_OPERAND, grp); |
| if (arg != nullptr && *arg == '\0') |
| arg = nullptr; |
| |
| watch_command_1 (arg, accessflag, from_tty, opts.location, false); |
| } |
| |
| /* Command completion for 'watch', 'awatch', and 'rwatch' commands. */ |
| static void |
| watch_command_completer (struct cmd_list_element *ignore, |
| completion_tracker &tracker, |
| const char *text, const char * /*word*/) |
| { |
| const auto group = make_watch_options_def_group (nullptr); |
| if (gdb::option::complete_options |
| (tracker, &text, gdb::option::PROCESS_OPTIONS_UNKNOWN_IS_OPERAND, group)) |
| return; |
| |
| const char *word = advance_to_expression_complete_word_point (tracker, text); |
| expression_completer (ignore, tracker, text, word); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| watch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) |
| { |
| watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_write, from_tty); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| rwatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, bool internal) |
| { |
| watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty, 0, internal); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| rwatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) |
| { |
| watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_read, from_tty); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| awatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, bool internal) |
| { |
| watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty, 0, internal); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| awatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) |
| { |
| watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_access, from_tty); |
| } |
| |
| |
| /* Data for the FSM that manages the until(location)/advance commands |
| in infcmd.c. Here because it uses the mechanisms of |
| breakpoints. */ |
| |
| struct until_break_fsm : public thread_fsm |
| { |
| /* The thread that was current when the command was executed. */ |
| int thread; |
| |
| /* The breakpoint set at the return address in the caller frame, |
| plus breakpoints at all the destination locations. */ |
| std::vector<breakpoint_up> breakpoints; |
| |
| until_break_fsm (struct interp *cmd_interp, int thread, |
| std::vector<breakpoint_up> &&breakpoints) |
| : thread_fsm (cmd_interp), |
| thread (thread), |
| breakpoints (std::move (breakpoints)) |
| { |
| } |
| |
| void clean_up (struct thread_info *thread) override; |
| bool should_stop (struct thread_info *thread) override; |
| enum async_reply_reason do_async_reply_reason () override; |
| }; |
| |
| /* Implementation of the 'should_stop' FSM method for the |
| until(location)/advance commands. */ |
| |
| bool |
| until_break_fsm::should_stop (struct thread_info *tp) |
| { |
| for (const breakpoint_up &bp : breakpoints) |
| if (bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat, |
| bp.get ()) != NULL) |
| { |
| set_finished (); |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| /* Implementation of the 'clean_up' FSM method for the |
| until(location)/advance commands. */ |
| |
| void |
| until_break_fsm::clean_up (struct thread_info *) |
| { |
| /* Clean up our temporary breakpoints. */ |
| breakpoints.clear (); |
| delete_longjmp_breakpoint (thread); |
| } |
| |
| /* Implementation of the 'async_reply_reason' FSM method for the |
| until(location)/advance commands. */ |
| |
| enum async_reply_reason |
| until_break_fsm::do_async_reply_reason () |
| { |
| return EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| until_break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere) |
| { |
| struct frame_info *frame; |
| struct gdbarch *frame_gdbarch; |
| struct frame_id stack_frame_id; |
| struct frame_id caller_frame_id; |
| int thread; |
| struct thread_info *tp; |
| |
| clear_proceed_status (0); |
| |
| /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from |
| this function. */ |
| |
| event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language); |
| |
| std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals |
| = (last_displayed_sal_is_valid () |
| ? decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL, |
| get_last_displayed_symtab (), |
| get_last_displayed_line ()) |
| : decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, |
| NULL, NULL, 0)); |
| |
| if (sals.empty ()) |
| error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line.")); |
| |
| if (*arg) |
| error (_("Junk at end of arguments.")); |
| |
| tp = inferior_thread (); |
| thread = tp->global_num; |
| |
| /* Note linespec handling above invalidates the frame chain. |
| Installing a breakpoint also invalidates the frame chain (as it |
| may need to switch threads), so do any frame handling before |
| that. */ |
| |
| frame = get_selected_frame (NULL); |
| frame_gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame); |
| stack_frame_id = get_stack_frame_id (frame); |
| caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame); |
| |
| /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current |
| one. */ |
| |
| std::vector<breakpoint_up> breakpoints; |
| |
| gdb::optional<delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup> lj_deleter; |
| |
| if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id)) |
| { |
| struct symtab_and_line sal2; |
| struct gdbarch *caller_gdbarch; |
| |
| sal2 = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0); |
| sal2.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame); |
| caller_gdbarch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame); |
| |
| breakpoint_up caller_breakpoint |
| = set_momentary_breakpoint (caller_gdbarch, sal2, |
| caller_frame_id, bp_until); |
| breakpoints.emplace_back (std::move (caller_breakpoint)); |
| |
| set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp, caller_frame_id); |
| lj_deleter.emplace (thread); |
| } |
| |
| /* set_momentary_breakpoint could invalidate FRAME. */ |
| frame = NULL; |
| |
| /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location, we |
| don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. Otherwise, |
| specify the selected frame, because we want to stop only at the |
| very same frame. */ |
| frame_id stop_frame_id = anywhere ? null_frame_id : stack_frame_id; |
| |
| for (symtab_and_line &sal : sals) |
| { |
| resolve_sal_pc (&sal); |
| |
| breakpoint_up location_breakpoint |
| = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal, |
| stop_frame_id, bp_until); |
| breakpoints.emplace_back (std::move (location_breakpoint)); |
| } |
| |
| tp->set_thread_fsm |
| (std::unique_ptr<thread_fsm> |
| (new until_break_fsm (command_interp (), tp->global_num, |
| std::move (breakpoints)))); |
| |
| if (lj_deleter) |
| lj_deleter->release (); |
| |
| proceed (-1, GDB_SIGNAL_DEFAULT); |
| } |
| |
| |
| |
| /* Compare two breakpoints and return a strcmp-like result. */ |
| |
| static int |
| compare_breakpoints (const breakpoint *a, const breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| uintptr_t ua = (uintptr_t) a; |
| uintptr_t ub = (uintptr_t) b; |
| |
| if (a->number < b->number) |
| return -1; |
| else if (a->number > b->number) |
| return 1; |
| |
| /* Now sort by address, in case we see, e..g, two breakpoints with |
| the number 0. */ |
| if (ua < ub) |
| return -1; |
| return ua > ub ? 1 : 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */ |
| |
| static void |
| clear_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) |
| { |
| int default_match; |
| |
| std::vector<symtab_and_line> decoded_sals; |
| symtab_and_line last_sal; |
| gdb::array_view<symtab_and_line> sals; |
| if (arg) |
| { |
| decoded_sals |
| = decode_line_with_current_source (arg, |
| (DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE |
| | DECODE_LINE_LIST_MODE)); |
| default_match = 0; |
| sals = decoded_sals; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* Set sal's line, symtab, pc, and pspace to the values |
| corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. If the |
| codepoint is not valid, this will set all the fields to 0. */ |
| last_sal = get_last_displayed_sal (); |
| if (last_sal.symtab == 0) |
| error (_("No source file specified.")); |
| |
| default_match = 1; |
| sals = last_sal; |
| } |
| |
| /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not as bad as it |
| seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both |
| file/line and pc set. So, if clear is given file/line, we can |
| match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all. |
| |
| We only support clearing given the address explicitly |
| present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint |
| at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line, |
| due to optimization, all in one block. |
| |
| We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another |
| PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't |
| be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but |
| since the other PC value is never presented to user, user |
| can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important |
| to support that. */ |
| |
| /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it. Do |
| it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that |
| from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one |
| breakpoint. */ |
| |
| std::vector<struct breakpoint *> found; |
| for (const auto &sal : sals) |
| { |
| const char *sal_fullname; |
| |
| /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc. |
| If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line. |
| If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line |
| or at default pc. |
| |
| defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do |
| |
| 0 1 pc |
| 1 1 pc _and_ line |
| 0 0 line |
| 1 0 <can't happen> */ |
| |
| sal_fullname = (sal.symtab == NULL |
| ? NULL : symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab)); |
| |
| /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'. */ |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| { |
| int match = 0; |
| /* Are we going to delete b? */ |
| if (b->type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (b) |
| && user_breakpoint_p (b)) |
| { |
| for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ()) |
| { |
| /* If the user specified file:line, don't allow a PC |
| match. This matches historical gdb behavior. */ |
| int pc_match = (!sal.explicit_line |
| && sal.pc |
| && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace) |
| && (loc->address == sal.pc) |
| && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section) |
| || loc->section == sal.section)); |
| int line_match = 0; |
| |
| if ((default_match || sal.explicit_line) |
| && loc->symtab != NULL |
| && sal_fullname != NULL |
| && sal.pspace == loc->pspace |
| && loc->line_number == sal.line |
| && filename_cmp (symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab), |
| sal_fullname) == 0) |
| line_match = 1; |
| |
| if (pc_match || line_match) |
| { |
| match = 1; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (match) |
| found.push_back (b); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */ |
| if (found.empty ()) |
| { |
| if (arg) |
| error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg); |
| else |
| error (_("No breakpoint at this line.")); |
| } |
| |
| /* Remove duplicates from the vec. */ |
| std::sort (found.begin (), found.end (), |
| [] (const breakpoint *bp_a, const breakpoint *bp_b) |
| { |
| return compare_breakpoints (bp_a, bp_b) < 0; |
| }); |
| found.erase (std::unique (found.begin (), found.end (), |
| [] (const breakpoint *bp_a, const breakpoint *bp_b) |
| { |
| return compare_breakpoints (bp_a, bp_b) == 0; |
| }), |
| found.end ()); |
| |
| if (found.size () > 1) |
| from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one. */ |
| if (from_tty) |
| { |
| if (found.size () == 1) |
| gdb_printf (_("Deleted breakpoint ")); |
| else |
| gdb_printf (_("Deleted breakpoints ")); |
| } |
| |
| for (breakpoint *iter : found) |
| { |
| if (from_tty) |
| gdb_printf ("%d ", iter->number); |
| delete_breakpoint (iter); |
| } |
| if (from_tty) |
| gdb_putc ('\n'); |
| } |
| |
| /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and |
| all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not. |
| This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */ |
| |
| void |
| breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat *bs) |
| { |
| for (; bs; bs = bs->next) |
| if (bs->breakpoint_at |
| && bs->breakpoint_at->disposition == disp_del |
| && bs->stop) |
| delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at); |
| |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) |
| if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop) |
| delete_breakpoint (b); |
| } |
| |
| /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to |
| std::sort. Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what |
| bl_address_is_meaningful says), secondarily by ordering first |
| permanent elements and terciarily just ensuring the array is sorted |
| stable way despite std::sort being an unstable algorithm. */ |
| |
| static int |
| bp_location_is_less_than (const bp_location *a, const bp_location *b) |
| { |
| if (a->address != b->address) |
| return a->address < b->address; |
| |
| /* Sort locations at the same address by their pspace number, keeping |
| locations of the same inferior (in a multi-inferior environment) |
| grouped. */ |
| |
| if (a->pspace->num != b->pspace->num) |
| return a->pspace->num < b->pspace->num; |
| |
| /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */ |
| if (a->permanent != b->permanent) |
| return a->permanent > b->permanent; |
| |
| /* Sort by type in order to make duplicate determination easier. |
| See update_global_location_list. This is kept in sync with |
| breakpoint_locations_match. */ |
| if (a->loc_type < b->loc_type) |
| return true; |
| |
| /* Likewise, for range-breakpoints, sort by length. */ |
| if (a->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint |
| && b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint |
| && a->length < b->length) |
| return true; |
| |
| /* Make the internal GDB representation stable across GDB runs |
| where A and B memory inside GDB can differ. Breakpoint locations of |
| the same type at the same address can be sorted in arbitrary order. */ |
| |
| if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number) |
| return a->owner->number < b->owner->number; |
| |
| return a < b; |
| } |
| |
| /* Set bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max and |
| bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current |
| content of the bp_locations array. */ |
| |
| static void |
| bp_locations_target_extensions_update (void) |
| { |
| bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = 0; |
| bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0; |
| |
| for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) |
| { |
| CORE_ADDR start, end, addr; |
| |
| if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl)) |
| continue; |
| |
| start = bl->target_info.placed_address; |
| end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len; |
| |
| gdb_assert (bl->address >= start); |
| addr = bl->address - start; |
| if (addr > bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max) |
| bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = addr; |
| |
| /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */ |
| |
| gdb_assert (bl->address < end); |
| addr = end - bl->address; |
| if (addr > bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max) |
| bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Download tracepoint locations if they haven't been. */ |
| |
| static void |
| download_tracepoint_locations (void) |
| { |
| enum tribool can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN; |
| |
| scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread; |
| |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_tracepoints ()) |
| { |
| struct tracepoint *t; |
| int bp_location_downloaded = 0; |
| |
| if ((b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint |
| ? !may_insert_fast_tracepoints |
| : !may_insert_tracepoints)) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN) |
| { |
| if (target_can_download_tracepoint ()) |
| can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_TRUE; |
| else |
| can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_FALSE) |
| break; |
| |
| for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ()) |
| { |
| /* In tracepoint, locations are _never_ duplicated, so |
| should_be_inserted is equivalent to |
| unduplicated_should_be_inserted. */ |
| if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || bl->inserted) |
| continue; |
| |
| switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace); |
| |
| target_download_tracepoint (bl); |
| |
| bl->inserted = 1; |
| bp_location_downloaded = 1; |
| } |
| t = (struct tracepoint *) b; |
| t->number_on_target = b->number; |
| if (bp_location_downloaded) |
| gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Swap the insertion/duplication state between two locations. */ |
| |
| static void |
| swap_insertion (struct bp_location *left, struct bp_location *right) |
| { |
| const int left_inserted = left->inserted; |
| const int left_duplicate = left->duplicate; |
| const int left_needs_update = left->needs_update; |
| const struct bp_target_info left_target_info = left->target_info; |
| |
| /* Locations of tracepoints can never be duplicated. */ |
| if (is_tracepoint (left->owner)) |
| gdb_assert (!left->duplicate); |
| if (is_tracepoint (right->owner)) |
| gdb_assert (!right->duplicate); |
| |
| left->inserted = right->inserted; |
| left->duplicate = right->duplicate; |
| left->needs_update = right->needs_update; |
| left->target_info = right->target_info; |
| right->inserted = left_inserted; |
| right->duplicate = left_duplicate; |
| right->needs_update = left_needs_update; |
| right->target_info = left_target_info; |
| } |
| |
| /* Force the re-insertion of the locations at ADDRESS. This is called |
| once a new/deleted/modified duplicate location is found and we are evaluating |
| conditions on the target's side. Such conditions need to be updated on |
| the target. */ |
| |
| static void |
| force_breakpoint_reinsertion (struct bp_location *bl) |
| { |
| CORE_ADDR address = 0; |
| int pspace_num; |
| |
| address = bl->address; |
| pspace_num = bl->pspace->num; |
| |
| /* This is only meaningful if the target is |
| evaluating conditions and if the user has |
| opted for condition evaluation on the target's |
| side. */ |
| if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p () |
| || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) |
| return; |
| |
| /* Flag all breakpoint locations with this address and |
| the same program space as the location |
| as "its condition has changed". We need to |
| update the conditions on the target's side. */ |
| for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations_at_addr (address)) |
| { |
| if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner) |
| || pspace_num != loc->pspace->num) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* Flag the location appropriately. We use a different state to |
| let everyone know that we already updated the set of locations |
| with addr bl->address and program space bl->pspace. This is so |
| we don't have to keep calling these functions just to mark locations |
| that have already been marked. */ |
| loc->condition_changed = condition_updated; |
| |
| /* Free the agent expression bytecode as well. We will compute |
| it later on. */ |
| loc->cond_bytecode.reset (); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Called whether new breakpoints are created, or existing breakpoints |
| deleted, to update the global location list and recompute which |
| locations are duplicate of which. |
| |
| The INSERT_MODE flag determines whether locations may not, may, or |
| shall be inserted now. See 'enum ugll_insert_mode' for more |
| info. */ |
| |
| static void |
| update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode) |
| { |
| /* Last breakpoint location address that was marked for update. */ |
| CORE_ADDR last_addr = 0; |
| /* Last breakpoint location program space that was marked for update. */ |
| int last_pspace_num = -1; |
| |
| /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all |
| bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address. |
| Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never |
| duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of |
| breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations |
| once. */ |
| struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */ |
| struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */ |
| struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */ |
| struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */ |
| |
| /* Saved former bp_locations array which we compare against the newly |
| built bp_locations from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */ |
| std::vector<bp_location *> old_locations = std::move (bp_locations); |
| bp_locations.clear (); |
| |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ()) |
| bp_locations.push_back (loc); |
| |
| /* See if we need to "upgrade" a software breakpoint to a hardware |
| breakpoint. Do this before deciding whether locations are |
| duplicates. Also do this before sorting because sorting order |
| depends on location type. */ |
| for (bp_location *loc : bp_locations) |
| if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc)) |
| handle_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (loc); |
| |
| std::sort (bp_locations.begin (), bp_locations.end (), |
| bp_location_is_less_than); |
| |
| bp_locations_target_extensions_update (); |
| |
| /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the |
| new list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not |
| necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior -- |
| if there's another location at the same address (previously |
| marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the |
| location. |
| |
| LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current |
| and former bp_location array state respectively. */ |
| |
| size_t loc_i = 0; |
| for (bp_location *old_loc : old_locations) |
| { |
| /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found among the new locations. If |
| not, we have to free it. */ |
| int found_object = 0; |
| /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */ |
| int keep_in_target = 0; |
| int removed = 0; |
| |
| /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed. |
| Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */ |
| while (loc_i < bp_locations.size () |
| && bp_locations[loc_i]->address < old_loc->address) |
| loc_i++; |
| |
| for (size_t loc2_i = loc_i; |
| (loc2_i < bp_locations.size () |
| && bp_locations[loc2_i]->address == old_loc->address); |
| loc2_i++) |
| { |
| /* Check if this is a new/duplicated location or a duplicated |
| location that had its condition modified. If so, we want to send |
| its condition to the target if evaluation of conditions is taking |
| place there. */ |
| if (bp_locations[loc2_i]->condition_changed == condition_modified |
| && (last_addr != old_loc->address |
| || last_pspace_num != old_loc->pspace->num)) |
| { |
| force_breakpoint_reinsertion (bp_locations[loc2_i]); |
| last_pspace_num = old_loc->pspace->num; |
| } |
| |
| if (bp_locations[loc2_i] == old_loc) |
| found_object = 1; |
| } |
| |
| /* We have already handled this address, update it so that we don't |
| have to go through updates again. */ |
| last_addr = old_loc->address; |
| |
| /* Target-side condition evaluation: Handle deleted locations. */ |
| if (!found_object) |
| force_breakpoint_reinsertion (old_loc); |
| |
| /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if |
| there's maybe a new location at the same address. If so, |
| mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one. This is |
| needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint |
| at certain location is not inserted. */ |
| |
| if (old_loc->inserted) |
| { |
| /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove |
| it. */ |
| |
| if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc)) |
| { |
| /* The location is still present in the location list, |
| and still should be inserted. Don't do anything. */ |
| keep_in_target = 1; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* This location still exists, but it won't be kept in the |
| target since it may have been disabled. We proceed to |
| remove its target-side condition. */ |
| |
| /* The location is either no longer present, or got |
| disabled. See if there's another location at the |
| same address, in which case we don't need to remove |
| this one from the target. */ |
| |
| /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint. */ |
| if (bl_address_is_meaningful (old_loc)) |
| { |
| for (size_t loc2_i = loc_i; |
| (loc2_i < bp_locations.size () |
| && bp_locations[loc2_i]->address == old_loc->address); |
| loc2_i++) |
| { |
| bp_location *loc2 = bp_locations[loc2_i]; |
| |
| if (loc2 == old_loc) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc)) |
| { |
| /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to |
| access watchpoints, if the former are not |
| supported, but the latter are. */ |
| if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner)) |
| { |
| gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner)); |
| loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type; |
| } |
| |
| /* loc2 is a duplicated location. We need to check |
| if it should be inserted in case it will be |
| unduplicated. */ |
| if (unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc2)) |
| { |
| swap_insertion (old_loc, loc2); |
| keep_in_target = 1; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (!keep_in_target) |
| { |
| if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc)) |
| { |
| /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep |
| this location on the global list, and try to |
| remove it next time, but there's no particular |
| reason why we will succeed next time. |
| |
| Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still |
| valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint |
| only after calling us. */ |
| gdb_printf (_("warning: Error removing " |
| "breakpoint %d\n"), |
| old_loc->owner->number); |
| } |
| removed = 1; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (!found_object) |
| { |
| if (removed && target_is_non_stop_p () |
| && need_moribund_for_location_type (old_loc)) |
| { |
| /* This location was removed from the target. In |
| non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where |
| we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that |
| breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later. |
| We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such |
| SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this |
| breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it |
| after we see some number of events. The theory here |
| is that reporting of events should, "on the average", |
| be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all |
| threads that have anything of interest, and no longer |
| need to keep this breakpoint location around. We |
| don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of |
| mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint |
| SIGTRAP. |
| |
| The heuristic failing can be disastrous on |
| decr_pc_after_break targets. |
| |
| On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux, |
| if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP, |
| because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too |
| soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report |
| a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes |
| the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash |
| with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently |
| corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the |
| middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a |
| one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen |
| on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on |
| targets that do not support new thread events, like |
| remote, due to the heuristic depending on |
| thread_count. |
| |
| Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap |
| causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when |
| it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs |
| behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble. |
| |
| Since hardware watchpoint traps are always |
| distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to |
| apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations |
| around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint |
| traps we can no longer explain. */ |
| |
| process_stratum_target *proc_target = nullptr; |
| for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ()) |
| if (inf->pspace == old_loc->pspace) |
| { |
| proc_target = inf->process_target (); |
| break; |
| } |
| if (proc_target != nullptr) |
| old_loc->events_till_retirement |
| = 3 * (thread_count (proc_target) + 1); |
| else |
| old_loc->events_till_retirement = 1; |
| old_loc->owner = NULL; |
| |
| moribund_locations.push_back (old_loc); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| old_loc->owner = NULL; |
| decref_bp_location (&old_loc); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the |
| first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so |
| that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a |
| permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the |
| official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints |
| are sorted first for the same address. |
| |
| Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the |
| watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */ |
| |
| bp_loc_first = NULL; |
| wp_loc_first = NULL; |
| awp_loc_first = NULL; |
| rwp_loc_first = NULL; |
| |
| for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ()) |
| { |
| /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always |
| non-NULL. */ |
| struct bp_location **loc_first_p; |
| breakpoint *b = loc->owner; |
| |
| if (!unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc) |
| || !bl_address_is_meaningful (loc) |
| /* Don't detect duplicate for tracepoint locations because they are |
| never duplicated. See the comments in field `duplicate' of |
| `struct bp_location'. */ |
| || is_tracepoint (b)) |
| { |
| /* Clear the condition modification flag. */ |
| loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged; |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint) |
| loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first; |
| else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint) |
| loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first; |
| else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint) |
| loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first; |
| else |
| loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first; |
| |
| if (*loc_first_p == NULL |
| || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section) |
| || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p)) |
| { |
| *loc_first_p = loc; |
| loc->duplicate = 0; |
| |
| if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->condition_changed) |
| { |
| loc->needs_update = 1; |
| /* Clear the condition modification flag. */ |
| loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged; |
| } |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| |
| /* This and the above ensure the invariant that the first location |
| is not duplicated, and is the inserted one. |
| All following are marked as duplicated, and are not inserted. */ |
| if (loc->inserted) |
| swap_insertion (loc, *loc_first_p); |
| loc->duplicate = 1; |
| |
| /* Clear the condition modification flag. */ |
| loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged; |
| } |
| |
| if (insert_mode == UGLL_INSERT || breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now ()) |
| { |
| if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT) |
| insert_breakpoint_locations (); |
| else |
| { |
| /* Even though the caller told us to not insert new |
| locations, we may still need to update conditions on the |
| target's side of breakpoints that were already inserted |
| if the target is evaluating breakpoint conditions. We |
| only update conditions for locations that are marked |
| "needs_update". */ |
| update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT) |
| download_tracepoint_locations (); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| breakpoint_retire_moribund (void) |
| { |
| for (int ix = 0; ix < moribund_locations.size (); ++ix) |
| { |
| struct bp_location *loc = moribund_locations[ix]; |
| if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0) |
| { |
| decref_bp_location (&loc); |
| unordered_remove (moribund_locations, ix); |
| --ix; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode) |
| { |
| |
| try |
| { |
| update_global_location_list (insert_mode); |
| } |
| catch (const gdb_exception_error &e) |
| { |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Clear BKP from a BPS. */ |
| |
| static void |
| bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat *bps, struct breakpoint *bpt) |
| { |
| bpstat *bs; |
| |
| for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next) |
| if (bs->breakpoint_at == bpt) |
| { |
| bs->breakpoint_at = NULL; |
| bs->old_val = NULL; |
| /* bs->commands will be freed later. */ |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */ |
| static int |
| bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data) |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *bpt = (struct breakpoint *) data; |
| |
| bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->control.stop_bpstat, bpt); |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Helper for breakpoint and tracepoint breakpoint->mention |
| callbacks. */ |
| |
| static void |
| say_where (const breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| struct value_print_options opts; |
| |
| get_user_print_options (&opts); |
| |
| /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a |
| single string. */ |
| if (b->loc == NULL) |
| { |
| /* For pending locations, the output differs slightly based |
| on b->extra_string. If this is non-NULL, it contains either |
| a condition or dprintf arguments. */ |
| if (b->extra_string == NULL) |
| { |
| gdb_printf (_(" (%s) pending."), |
| event_location_to_string (b->location.get ())); |
| } |
| else if (b->type == bp_dprintf) |
| { |
| gdb_printf (_(" (%s,%s) pending."), |
| event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()), |
| b->extra_string.get ()); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| gdb_printf (_(" (%s %s) pending."), |
| event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()), |
| b->extra_string.get ()); |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (opts.addressprint || b->loc->symtab == NULL) |
| gdb_printf (" at %ps", |
| styled_string (address_style.style (), |
| paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, |
| b->loc->address))); |
| if (b->loc->symtab != NULL) |
| { |
| /* If there is a single location, we can print the location |
| more nicely. */ |
| if (b->loc->next == NULL) |
| { |
| const char *filename |
| = symtab_to_filename_for_display (b->loc->symtab); |
| gdb_printf (": file %ps, line %d.", |
| styled_string (file_name_style.style (), |
| filename), |
| b->loc->line_number); |
| } |
| else |
| /* This is not ideal, but each location may have a |
| different file name, and this at least reflects the |
| real situation somewhat. */ |
| gdb_printf (": %s.", |
| event_location_to_string (b->location.get ())); |
| } |
| |
| if (b->loc->next) |
| { |
| struct bp_location *loc = b->loc; |
| int n = 0; |
| for (; loc; loc = loc->next) |
| ++n; |
| gdb_printf (" (%d locations)", n); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| bp_location_range breakpoint::locations () const |
| { |
| return bp_location_range (this->loc); |
| } |
| |
| struct bp_location * |
| breakpoint::allocate_location () |
| { |
| return new bp_location (this); |
| } |
| |
| #define internal_error_pure_virtual_called() \ |
| gdb_assert_not_reached ("pure virtual function called") |
| |
| int |
| breakpoint::insert_location (struct bp_location *bl) |
| { |
| internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); |
| } |
| |
| int |
| breakpoint::remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, |
| enum remove_bp_reason reason) |
| { |
| internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); |
| } |
| |
| int |
| breakpoint::breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, |
| const address_space *aspace, |
| CORE_ADDR bp_addr, |
| const target_waitstatus &ws) |
| { |
| internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); |
| } |
| |
| int |
| breakpoint::resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl) |
| { |
| internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); |
| } |
| |
| enum print_stop_action |
| breakpoint::print_it (const bpstat *bs) const |
| { |
| internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| breakpoint::print_mention () const |
| { |
| internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| breakpoint::print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const |
| { |
| internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); |
| } |
| |
| std::vector<symtab_and_line> |
| breakpoint::decode_location (struct event_location *location, |
| struct program_space *search_pspace) |
| { |
| internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); |
| } |
| |
| /* Default breakpoint_ops methods. */ |
| |
| void |
| base_breakpoint::re_set () |
| { |
| /* FIXME: is this still reachable? */ |
| if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (this)) |
| { |
| /* Anything without a location can't be re-set. */ |
| delete_breakpoint (this); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| breakpoint_re_set_default (this); |
| } |
| |
| int |
| base_breakpoint::insert_location (struct bp_location *bl) |
| { |
| CORE_ADDR addr = bl->target_info.reqstd_address; |
| |
| bl->target_info.kind = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr); |
| bl->target_info.placed_address = addr; |
| |
| int result; |
| if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) |
| result = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info); |
| else |
| result = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info); |
| |
| if (result == 0 && bl->probe.prob != nullptr) |
| { |
| /* The insertion was successful, now let's set the probe's semaphore |
| if needed. */ |
| bl->probe.prob->set_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch); |
| } |
| |
| return result; |
| } |
| |
| int |
| base_breakpoint::remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, |
| enum remove_bp_reason reason) |
| { |
| if (bl->probe.prob != nullptr) |
| { |
| /* Let's clear the semaphore before removing the location. */ |
| bl->probe.prob->clear_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch); |
| } |
| |
| if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) |
| return target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info); |
| else |
| return target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info, reason); |
| } |
| |
| int |
| base_breakpoint::breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, |
| const address_space *aspace, |
| CORE_ADDR bp_addr, |
| const target_waitstatus &ws) |
| { |
| if (ws.kind () != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED |
| || ws.sig () != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP) |
| return 0; |
| |
| if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address, |
| aspace, bp_addr)) |
| return 0; |
| |
| if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */ |
| && section_is_overlay (bl->section) |
| && !section_is_mapped (bl->section)) |
| return 0; |
| |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| int |
| dprintf_breakpoint::breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, |
| const address_space *aspace, |
| CORE_ADDR bp_addr, |
| const target_waitstatus &ws) |
| { |
| if (dprintf_style == dprintf_style_agent |
| && target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ()) |
| { |
| /* An agent-style dprintf never causes a stop. If we see a trap |
| for this address it must be for a breakpoint that happens to |
| be set at the same address. */ |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| return this->ordinary_breakpoint::breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws); |
| } |
| |
| int |
| ordinary_breakpoint::resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl) |
| { |
| gdb_assert (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint); |
| |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| enum print_stop_action |
| ordinary_breakpoint::print_it (const bpstat *bs) const |
| { |
| const struct bp_location *bl; |
| int bp_temp; |
| struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; |
| |
| bl = bs->bp_location_at.get (); |
| |
| bp_temp = disposition == disp_del; |
| if (bl->address != bl->requested_address) |
| breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address, |
| bl->address, |
| number, 1); |
| annotate_breakpoint (number); |
| maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout); |
| |
| if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) |
| { |
| uiout->field_string ("reason", |
| async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT)); |
| uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (disposition)); |
| } |
| if (bp_temp) |
| uiout->message ("Temporary breakpoint %pF, ", |
| signed_field ("bkptno", number)); |
| else |
| uiout->message ("Breakpoint %pF, ", |
| signed_field ("bkptno", number)); |
| |
| return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| ordinary_breakpoint::print_mention () const |
| { |
| if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) |
| return; |
| |
| switch (type) |
| { |
| case bp_breakpoint: |
| case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver: |
| if (disposition == disp_del) |
| gdb_printf (_("Temporary breakpoint")); |
| else |
| gdb_printf (_("Breakpoint")); |
| gdb_printf (_(" %d"), number); |
| if (type == bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver) |
| gdb_printf (_(" at gnu-indirect-function resolver")); |
| break; |
| case bp_hardware_breakpoint: |
| gdb_printf (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), number); |
| break; |
| case bp_dprintf: |
| gdb_printf (_("Dprintf %d"), number); |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| say_where (this); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| ordinary_breakpoint::print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const |
| { |
| if (type == bp_breakpoint && disposition == disp_del) |
| gdb_printf (fp, "tbreak"); |
| else if (type == bp_breakpoint) |
| gdb_printf (fp, "break"); |
| else if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint |
| && disposition == disp_del) |
| gdb_printf (fp, "thbreak"); |
| else if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint) |
| gdb_printf (fp, "hbreak"); |
| else |
| internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, |
| _("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) type); |
| |
| gdb_printf (fp, " %s", event_location_to_string (location.get ())); |
| |
| /* Print out extra_string if this breakpoint is pending. It might |
| contain, for example, conditions that were set by the user. */ |
| if (loc == NULL && extra_string != NULL) |
| gdb_printf (fp, " %s", extra_string.get ()); |
| |
| print_recreate_thread (fp); |
| } |
| |
| std::vector<symtab_and_line> |
| base_breakpoint::decode_location (struct event_location *location, |
| struct program_space *search_pspace) |
| { |
| if (event_location_type (location) == PROBE_LOCATION) |
| return bkpt_probe_decode_location (this, location, search_pspace); |
| |
| return decode_location_default (this, location, search_pspace); |
| } |
| |
| /* Virtual table for internal breakpoints. */ |
| |
| void |
| internal_breakpoint::re_set () |
| { |
| switch (type) |
| { |
| /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they |
| will be reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */ |
| case bp_overlay_event: |
| case bp_longjmp_master: |
| case bp_std_terminate_master: |
| case bp_exception_master: |
| delete_breakpoint (this); |
| break; |
| |
| /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior |
| starts and we really don't want to touch it. */ |
| case bp_shlib_event: |
| |
| /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special. Once |
| it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */ |
| case bp_thread_event: |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| void |
| internal_breakpoint::check_status (bpstat *bs) |
| { |
| if (type == bp_shlib_event) |
| { |
| /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB of |
| events. This allows the user to get control and place |
| breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically loaded |
| objects (among other things). */ |
| bs->stop = stop_on_solib_events; |
| bs->print = stop_on_solib_events; |
| } |
| else |
| bs->stop = 0; |
| } |
| |
| enum print_stop_action |
| internal_breakpoint::print_it (const bpstat *bs) const |
| { |
| switch (type) |
| { |
| case bp_shlib_event: |
| /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events |
| variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due |
| to shlib event" message.) */ |
| print_solib_event (false); |
| break; |
| |
| case bp_thread_event: |
| /* Not sure how we will get here. |
| GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */ |
| gdb_printf (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n")); |
| break; |
| |
| case bp_overlay_event: |
| /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */ |
| gdb_printf (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n")); |
| break; |
| |
| case bp_longjmp_master: |
| /* These should never be enabled. */ |
| gdb_printf (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n")); |
| break; |
| |
| case bp_std_terminate_master: |
| /* These should never be enabled. */ |
| gdb_printf (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: " |
| "gdb should not stop!\n")); |
| break; |
| |
| case bp_exception_master: |
| /* These should never be enabled. */ |
| gdb_printf (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: " |
| "gdb should not stop!\n")); |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| return PRINT_NOTHING; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| internal_breakpoint::print_mention () const |
| { |
| /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */ |
| } |
| |
| /* Virtual table for momentary breakpoints */ |
| |
| void |
| momentary_breakpoint::re_set () |
| { |
| /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step |
| over a dlopen call and solib_add is resetting the breakpoints. |
| Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain |
| or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */ |
| } |
| |
| void |
| momentary_breakpoint::check_status (bpstat *bs) |
| { |
| /* Nothing. The point of these breakpoints is causing a stop. */ |
| } |
| |
| enum print_stop_action |
| momentary_breakpoint::print_it (const bpstat *bs) const |
| { |
| return PRINT_UNKNOWN; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| momentary_breakpoint::print_mention () const |
| { |
| /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */ |
| } |
| |
| /* Ensure INITIATING_FRAME is cleared when no such breakpoint exists. |
| |
| It gets cleared already on the removal of the first one of such placed |
| breakpoints. This is OK as they get all removed altogether. */ |
| |
| longjmp_breakpoint::~longjmp_breakpoint () |
| { |
| thread_info *tp = find_thread_global_id (this->thread); |
| |
| if (tp != NULL) |
| tp->initiating_frame = null_frame_id; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (struct event_location *location, |
| struct linespec_result *canonical) |
| |
| { |
| struct linespec_sals lsal; |
| |
| lsal.sals = parse_probes (location, NULL, canonical); |
| lsal.canonical |
| = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ())); |
| canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal)); |
| } |
| |
| static std::vector<symtab_and_line> |
| bkpt_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b, |
| struct event_location *location, |
| struct program_space *search_pspace) |
| { |
| std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = parse_probes (location, search_pspace, NULL); |
| if (sals.empty ()) |
| error (_("probe not found")); |
| return sals; |
| } |
| |
| int |
| tracepoint::breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, |
| const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr, |
| const target_waitstatus &ws) |
| { |
| /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at |
| tracepoints. */ |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| tracepoint::print_one_detail (struct ui_out *uiout) const |
| { |
| if (!static_trace_marker_id.empty ()) |
| { |
| gdb_assert (type == bp_static_tracepoint |
| || type == bp_static_marker_tracepoint); |
| |
| uiout->message ("\tmarker id is %pF\n", |
| string_field ("static-tracepoint-marker-string-id", |
| static_trace_marker_id.c_str ())); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| void |
| tracepoint::print_mention () const |
| { |
| if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) |
| return; |
| |
| switch (type) |
| { |
| case bp_tracepoint: |
| gdb_printf (_("Tracepoint")); |
| gdb_printf (_(" %d"), number); |
| break; |
| case bp_fast_tracepoint: |
| gdb_printf (_("Fast tracepoint")); |
| gdb_printf (_(" %d"), number); |
| break; |
| case bp_static_tracepoint: |
| case bp_static_marker_tracepoint: |
| gdb_printf (_("Static tracepoint")); |
| gdb_printf (_(" %d"), number); |
| break; |
| default: |
| internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, |
| _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) type); |
| } |
| |
| say_where (this); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| tracepoint::print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const |
| { |
| if (type == bp_fast_tracepoint) |
| gdb_printf (fp, "ftrace"); |
| else if (type == bp_static_tracepoint |
| || type == bp_static_marker_tracepoint) |
| gdb_printf (fp, "strace"); |
| else if (type == bp_tracepoint) |
| gdb_printf (fp, "trace"); |
| else |
| internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, |
| _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) type); |
| |
| gdb_printf (fp, " %s", event_location_to_string (location.get ())); |
| print_recreate_thread (fp); |
| |
| if (pass_count) |
| gdb_printf (fp, " passcount %d\n", pass_count); |
| } |
| |
| /* Virtual table for tracepoints on static probes. */ |
| |
| static void |
| tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location |
| (struct event_location *location, |
| struct linespec_result *canonical) |
| { |
| /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */ |
| bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (location, canonical); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| dprintf_breakpoint::re_set () |
| { |
| breakpoint_re_set_default (this); |
| |
| /* extra_string should never be non-NULL for dprintf. */ |
| gdb_assert (extra_string != NULL); |
| |
| /* 1 - connect to target 1, that can run breakpoint commands. |
| 2 - create a dprintf, which resolves fine. |
| 3 - disconnect from target 1 |
| 4 - connect to target 2, that can NOT run breakpoint commands. |
| |
| After steps #3/#4, you'll want the dprintf command list to |
| be updated, because target 1 and 2 may well return different |
| answers for target_can_run_breakpoint_commands(). |
| Given absence of finer grained resetting, we get to do |
| it all the time. */ |
| if (extra_string != NULL) |
| update_dprintf_command_list (this); |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement the "print_recreate" method for dprintf. */ |
| |
| void |
| dprintf_breakpoint::print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const |
| { |
| gdb_printf (fp, "dprintf %s,%s", |
| event_location_to_string (location.get ()), |
| extra_string.get ()); |
| print_recreate_thread (fp); |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement the "after_condition_true" method for dprintf. |
| |
| dprintf's are implemented with regular commands in their command |
| list, but we run the commands here instead of before presenting the |
| stop to the user, as dprintf's don't actually cause a stop. This |
| also makes it so that the commands of multiple dprintfs at the same |
| address are all handled. */ |
| |
| void |
| dprintf_breakpoint::after_condition_true (struct bpstat *bs) |
| { |
| /* dprintf's never cause a stop. This wasn't set in the |
| check_status hook instead because that would make the dprintf's |
| condition not be evaluated. */ |
| bs->stop = 0; |
| |
| /* Run the command list here. Take ownership of it instead of |
| copying. We never want these commands to run later in |
| bpstat_do_actions, if a breakpoint that causes a stop happens to |
| be set at same address as this dprintf, or even if running the |
| commands here throws. */ |
| counted_command_line cmds = std::move (bs->commands); |
| gdb_assert (cmds != nullptr); |
| execute_control_commands (cmds.get (), 0); |
| } |
| |
| /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used on static tracepoints with |
| markers (`-m'). */ |
| |
| static void |
| strace_marker_create_sals_from_location (struct event_location *location, |
| struct linespec_result *canonical) |
| { |
| struct linespec_sals lsal; |
| const char *arg_start, *arg; |
| |
| arg = arg_start = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string; |
| lsal.sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&arg); |
| |
| std::string str (arg_start, arg - arg_start); |
| const char *ptr = str.c_str (); |
| canonical->location |
| = new_linespec_location (&ptr, symbol_name_match_type::FULL); |
| |
| lsal.canonical |
| = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ())); |
| canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal)); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, |
| struct linespec_result *canonical, |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string, |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string, |
| enum bptype type_wanted, |
| enum bpdisp disposition, |
| int thread, |
| int task, int ignore_count, |
| int from_tty, int enabled, |
| int internal, unsigned flags) |
| { |
| const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical->lsals[0]; |
| |
| /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id |
| (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that |
| breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly |
| found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to |
| expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS |
| already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID. */ |
| |
| for (size_t i = 0; i < lsal.sals.size (); i++) |
| { |
| event_location_up location |
| = copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ()); |
| |
| std::unique_ptr<tracepoint> tp |
| (new tracepoint (gdbarch, |
| type_wanted, |
| lsal.sals[i], |
| std::move (location), |
| NULL, |
| std::move (cond_string), |
| std::move (extra_string), |
| disposition, |
| thread, task, ignore_count, |
| from_tty, enabled, flags, |
| canonical->special_display)); |
| |
| /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with |
| the same string id, if the user is creating a static |
| tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then |
| store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can |
| try to match up which of the newly found markers |
| corresponds to this one */ |
| tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i; |
| |
| install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (tp), 0); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| std::vector<symtab_and_line> |
| static_marker_tracepoint::decode_location (struct event_location *location, |
| struct program_space *search_pspace) |
| { |
| const char *s = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string; |
| |
| std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&s); |
| if (sals.size () > static_trace_marker_id_idx) |
| { |
| sals[0] = sals[static_trace_marker_id_idx]; |
| sals.resize (1); |
| return sals; |
| } |
| else |
| error (_("marker %s not found"), static_trace_marker_id.c_str ()); |
| } |
| |
| /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m'). */ |
| static struct breakpoint_ops strace_marker_breakpoint_ops = |
| { |
| strace_marker_create_sals_from_location, |
| strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal, |
| }; |
| |
| static int |
| strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| return b->type == bp_static_marker_tracepoint; |
| } |
| |
| /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data |
| structures. */ |
| |
| void |
| delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt) |
| { |
| gdb_assert (bpt != NULL); |
| |
| /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because |
| multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are |
| especial culprits. |
| |
| One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When |
| the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of |
| scope, and delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the |
| scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat. |
| That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are |
| deleted. |
| |
| A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in |
| bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing |
| bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's |
| storage when no more references were extent. A cheaper bandaid |
| was chosen. */ |
| if (bpt->type == bp_none) |
| return; |
| |
| /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting |
| of breakpoints gets resolved. */ |
| if (bpt->related_breakpoint != bpt) |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *related; |
| struct watchpoint *w; |
| |
| if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope) |
| w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt->related_breakpoint; |
| else if (bpt->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope) |
| w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt; |
| else |
| w = NULL; |
| if (w != NULL) |
| watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (w); |
| |
| /* Unlink bpt from the bpt->related_breakpoint ring. */ |
| for (related = bpt; related->related_breakpoint != bpt; |
| related = related->related_breakpoint); |
| related->related_breakpoint = bpt->related_breakpoint; |
| bpt->related_breakpoint = bpt; |
| } |
| |
| /* watch_command_1 creates a watchpoint but only sets its number if |
| update_watchpoint succeeds in creating its bp_locations. If there's |
| a problem in that process, we'll be asked to delete the half-created |
| watchpoint. In that case, don't announce the deletion. */ |
| if (bpt->number) |
| gdb::observers::breakpoint_deleted.notify (bpt); |
| |
| if (breakpoint_chain == bpt) |
| breakpoint_chain = bpt->next; |
| |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| if (b->next == bpt) |
| { |
| b->next = bpt->next; |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's |
| been freed. */ |
| /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's? We just check stop_bpstat |
| in all threads for now. Note that we cannot just remove bpstats |
| pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint |
| commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here, |
| then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in |
| event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with |
| commands won't work. */ |
| |
| iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt); |
| |
| /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the |
| global location list. This will remove locations that used to |
| belong to this breakpoint. Do this before freeing the breakpoint |
| itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner. It |
| might be better design to have location completely |
| self-contained, but it's not the case now. */ |
| update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); |
| |
| /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this |
| same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */ |
| bpt->type = bp_none; |
| delete bpt; |
| } |
| |
| /* Iterator function to call a user-provided callback function once |
| for each of B and its related breakpoints. */ |
| |
| static void |
| iterate_over_related_breakpoints (struct breakpoint *b, |
| gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function) |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *related; |
| |
| related = b; |
| do |
| { |
| struct breakpoint *next; |
| |
| /* FUNCTION may delete RELATED. */ |
| next = related->related_breakpoint; |
| |
| if (next == related) |
| { |
| /* RELATED is the last ring entry. */ |
| function (related); |
| |
| /* FUNCTION may have deleted it, so we'd never reach back to |
| B. There's nothing left to do anyway, so just break |
| out. */ |
| break; |
| } |
| else |
| function (related); |
| |
| related = next; |
| } |
| while (related != b); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| delete_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) |
| { |
| dont_repeat (); |
| |
| if (arg == 0) |
| { |
| int breaks_to_delete = 0; |
| |
| /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument. Do not delete |
| internal breakpoints, these have to be deleted with an |
| explicit breakpoint number argument. */ |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| if (user_breakpoint_p (b)) |
| { |
| breaks_to_delete = 1; |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */ |
| if (!from_tty |
| || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? ")))) |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) |
| if (user_breakpoint_p (b)) |
| delete_breakpoint (b); |
| } |
| else |
| map_breakpoint_numbers |
| (arg, [&] (breakpoint *br) |
| { |
| iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br, delete_breakpoint); |
| }); |
| } |
| |
| /* Return true if all locations of B bound to PSPACE are pending. If |
| PSPACE is NULL, all locations of all program spaces are |
| considered. */ |
| |
| static int |
| all_locations_are_pending (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace) |
| { |
| for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ()) |
| if ((pspace == NULL |
| || loc->pspace == pspace) |
| && !loc->shlib_disabled |
| && !loc->pspace->executing_startup) |
| return 0; |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it. |
| Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name. |
| Null names are ignored. */ |
| |
| static int |
| ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc) |
| { |
| struct bp_location *l; |
| htab_up htab (htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string, htab_eq_string, NULL, |
| xcalloc, xfree)); |
| |
| for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next) |
| { |
| const char **slot; |
| const char *name = l->function_name.get (); |
| |
| /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */ |
| if (name == NULL) |
| continue; |
| |
| slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab.get (), (const void *) name, |
| INSERT); |
| /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never |
| returns NULL. */ |
| if (*slot != NULL) |
| return 1; |
| *slot = name; |
| } |
| |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well, |
| and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at |
| the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we |
| checked. Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is |
| undesirable. This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static |
| tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints |
| that have not been set by marker id. Static tracepoint that have |
| been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set. |
| The heuristic is: |
| |
| 1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at |
| the old PC. If one is found there, assume to be the same marker. |
| If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the |
| previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker |
| in the sources, and output a warning. |
| |
| 2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker |
| at the new address of the old line number. If one is found there, |
| assume to be the same marker. If the name / string id of the |
| marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that |
| means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a |
| warning. |
| |
| 3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it |
| may mean the marker no longer exists. But it may also just mean |
| the code changed a bit. Maybe the user added a few lines of code |
| that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms). Ask |
| the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew |
| it. If found, update line number and address in the matching |
| static tracepoint. This will get confused if there's more than one |
| marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised |
| precisely because it confuses tools). */ |
| |
| static struct symtab_and_line |
| update_static_tracepoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct symtab_and_line sal) |
| { |
| struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b; |
| struct static_tracepoint_marker marker; |
| CORE_ADDR pc; |
| |
| pc = sal.pc; |
| if (sal.line) |
| find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc); |
| |
| if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker)) |
| { |
| if (tp->static_trace_marker_id != marker.str_id) |
| warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"), |
| b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str (), |
| marker.str_id.c_str ()); |
| |
| tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id); |
| |
| return sal; |
| } |
| |
| /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno. Try looking it up |
| by string ID. */ |
| if (!sal.explicit_pc |
| && sal.line != 0 |
| && sal.symtab != NULL |
| && !tp->static_trace_marker_id.empty ()) |
| { |
| std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers |
| = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid |
| (tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ()); |
| |
| if (!markers.empty ()) |
| { |
| struct symbol *sym; |
| struct static_tracepoint_marker *tpmarker; |
| struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; |
| struct explicit_location explicit_loc; |
| |
| tpmarker = &markers[0]; |
| |
| tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (tpmarker->str_id); |
| |
| warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not " |
| "found at previous line number"), |
| b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ()); |
| |
| symtab_and_line sal2 = find_pc_line (tpmarker->address, 0); |
| sym = find_pc_sect_function (tpmarker->address, NULL); |
| uiout->text ("Now in "); |
| if (sym) |
| { |
| uiout->field_string ("func", sym->print_name (), |
| function_name_style.style ()); |
| uiout->text (" at "); |
| } |
| uiout->field_string ("file", |
| symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab), |
| file_name_style.style ()); |
| uiout->text (":"); |
| |
| if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) |
| { |
| const char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal2.symtab); |
| |
| uiout->field_string ("fullname", fullname); |
| } |
| |
| uiout->field_signed ("line", sal2.line); |
| uiout->text ("\n"); |
| |
| b->loc->line_number = sal2.line; |
| b->loc->symtab = sym != NULL ? sal2.symtab : NULL; |
| |
| b->location.reset (NULL); |
| initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc); |
| explicit_loc.source_filename |
| = ASTRDUP (symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab)); |
| explicit_loc.line_offset.offset = b->loc->line_number; |
| explicit_loc.line_offset.sign = LINE_OFFSET_NONE; |
| b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc); |
| |
| /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if |
| so. */ |
| } |
| } |
| return sal; |
| } |
| |
| /* Returns 1 iff locations A and B are sufficiently same that |
| we don't need to report breakpoint as changed. */ |
| |
| static int |
| locations_are_equal (struct bp_location *a, struct bp_location *b) |
| { |
| while (a && b) |
| { |
| if (a->address != b->address) |
| return 0; |
| |
| if (a->shlib_disabled != b->shlib_disabled) |
| return 0; |
| |
| if (a->enabled != b->enabled) |
| return 0; |
| |
| if (a->disabled_by_cond != b->disabled_by_cond) |
| return 0; |
| |
| a = a->next; |
| b = b->next; |
| } |
| |
| if ((a == NULL) != (b == NULL)) |
| return 0; |
| |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| /* Split all locations of B that are bound to PSPACE out of B's |
| location list to a separate list and return that list's head. If |
| PSPACE is NULL, hoist out all locations of B. */ |
| |
| static struct bp_location * |
| hoist_existing_locations (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace) |
| { |
| struct bp_location head; |
| struct bp_location *i = b->loc; |
| struct bp_location **i_link = &b->loc; |
| struct bp_location *hoisted = &head; |
| |
| if (pspace == NULL) |
| { |
| i = b->loc; |
| b->loc = NULL; |
| return i; |
| } |
| |
| head.next = NULL; |
| |
| while (i != NULL) |
| { |
| if (i->pspace == pspace) |
| { |
| *i_link = i->next; |
| i->next = NULL; |
| hoisted->next = i; |
| hoisted = i; |
| } |
| else |
| i_link = &i->next; |
| i = *i_link; |
| } |
| |
| return head.next; |
| } |
| |
| /* Create new breakpoint locations for B (a hardware or software |
| breakpoint) based on SALS and SALS_END. If SALS_END.NELTS is not |
| zero, then B is a ranged breakpoint. Only recreates locations for |
| FILTER_PSPACE. Locations of other program spaces are left |
| untouched. */ |
| |
| void |
| update_breakpoint_locations (base_breakpoint *b, |
| struct program_space *filter_pspace, |
| gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals, |
| gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals_end) |
| { |
| struct bp_location *existing_locations; |
| |
| if (!sals_end.empty () && (sals.size () != 1 || sals_end.size () != 1)) |
| { |
| /* Ranged breakpoints have only one start location and one end |
| location. */ |
| b->enable_state = bp_disabled; |
| gdb_printf (gdb_stderr, |
| _("Could not reset ranged breakpoint %d: " |
| "multiple locations found\n"), |
| b->number); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are |
| pending, don't do anything. This optimizes the common case where |
| all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded. |
| We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is |
| loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the |
| individual locations. */ |
| if (all_locations_are_pending (b, filter_pspace) && sals.empty ()) |
| return; |
| |
| existing_locations = hoist_existing_locations (b, filter_pspace); |
| |
| for (const auto &sal : sals) |
| { |
| struct bp_location *new_loc; |
| |
| switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace); |
| |
| new_loc = b->add_location (sal); |
| |
| /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the |
| old symtab. */ |
| if (b->cond_string != NULL) |
| { |
| const char *s; |
| |
| s = b->cond_string.get (); |
| try |
| { |
| new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, sal.pc, |
| block_for_pc (sal.pc), |
| 0); |
| } |
| catch (const gdb_exception_error &e) |
| { |
| new_loc->disabled_by_cond = true; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (!sals_end.empty ()) |
| { |
| CORE_ADDR end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sals_end[0]); |
| |
| new_loc->length = end - sals[0].pc + 1; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing |
| breakpoints. */ |
| { |
| struct bp_location *e = existing_locations; |
| /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name, |
| e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work. |
| Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things |
| may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer |
| often enough until a better solution is found. */ |
| int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc); |
| |
| for (; e; e = e->next) |
| { |
| if ((!e->enabled || e->disabled_by_cond) && e->function_name) |
| { |
| if (have_ambiguous_names) |
| { |
| for (bp_location *l : b->locations ()) |
| { |
| /* Ignore software vs hardware location type at |
| this point, because with "set breakpoint |
| auto-hw", after a re-set, locations that were |
| hardware can end up as software, or vice versa. |
| As mentioned above, this is an heuristic and in |
| practice should give the correct answer often |
| enough. */ |
| if (breakpoint_locations_match (e, l, true)) |
| { |
| l->enabled = e->enabled; |
| l->disabled_by_cond = e->disabled_by_cond; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| for (bp_location *l : b->locations ()) |
| if (l->function_name |
| && strcmp (e->function_name.get (), |
| l->function_name.get ()) == 0) |
| { |
| l->enabled = e->enabled; |
| l->disabled_by_cond = e->disabled_by_cond; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (!locations_are_equal (existing_locations, b->loc)) |
| gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b); |
| } |
| |
| /* Find the SaL locations corresponding to the given LOCATION. |
| On return, FOUND will be 1 if any SaL was found, zero otherwise. */ |
| |
| static std::vector<symtab_and_line> |
| location_to_sals (struct breakpoint *b, struct event_location *location, |
| struct program_space *search_pspace, int *found) |
| { |
| struct gdb_exception exception; |
| |
| std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals; |
| |
| try |
| { |
| sals = b->decode_location (location, search_pspace); |
| } |
| catch (gdb_exception_error &e) |
| { |
| int not_found_and_ok = 0; |
| |
| /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will |
| fail until the right shared library is loaded. User has |
| already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need |
| extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled |
| state, then user already saw the message about that |
| breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more |
| errors. */ |
| if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR |
| && (b->condition_not_parsed |
| || (b->loc != NULL |
| && search_pspace != NULL |
| && b->loc->pspace != search_pspace) |
| || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled) |
| || (b->loc && b->loc->pspace->executing_startup) |
| || b->enable_state == bp_disabled)) |
| not_found_and_ok = 1; |
| |
| if (!not_found_and_ok) |
| { |
| /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint |
| 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable |
| the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to |
| have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this |
| happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know |
| which approach is better. */ |
| b->enable_state = bp_disabled; |
| throw; |
| } |
| |
| exception = std::move (e); |
| } |
| |
| if (exception.reason == 0 || exception.error != NOT_FOUND_ERROR) |
| { |
| for (auto &sal : sals) |
| resolve_sal_pc (&sal); |
| if (b->condition_not_parsed && b->extra_string != NULL) |
| { |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string, extra_string; |
| int thread, task; |
| |
| find_condition_and_thread_for_sals (sals, b->extra_string.get (), |
| &cond_string, &thread, |
| &task, &extra_string); |
| gdb_assert (b->cond_string == NULL); |
| if (cond_string) |
| b->cond_string = std::move (cond_string); |
| b->thread = thread; |
| b->task = task; |
| if (extra_string) |
| b->extra_string = std::move (extra_string); |
| b->condition_not_parsed = 0; |
| } |
| |
| if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint) |
| sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (b, sals[0]); |
| |
| *found = 1; |
| } |
| else |
| *found = 0; |
| |
| return sals; |
| } |
| |
| /* The default re_set method, for typical hardware or software |
| breakpoints. Reevaluate the breakpoint and recreate its |
| locations. */ |
| |
| static void |
| breakpoint_re_set_default (base_breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| struct program_space *filter_pspace = current_program_space; |
| std::vector<symtab_and_line> expanded, expanded_end; |
| |
| int found; |
| std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = location_to_sals (b, b->location.get (), |
| filter_pspace, &found); |
| if (found) |
| expanded = std::move (sals); |
| |
| if (b->location_range_end != NULL) |
| { |
| std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals_end |
| = location_to_sals (b, b->location_range_end.get (), |
| filter_pspace, &found); |
| if (found) |
| expanded_end = std::move (sals_end); |
| } |
| |
| update_breakpoint_locations (b, filter_pspace, expanded, expanded_end); |
| } |
| |
| /* Default method for creating SALs from an address string. It basically |
| calls parse_breakpoint_sals. Return 1 for success, zero for failure. */ |
| |
| static void |
| create_sals_from_location_default (struct event_location *location, |
| struct linespec_result *canonical) |
| { |
| parse_breakpoint_sals (location, canonical); |
| } |
| |
| /* Decode the line represented by S by calling decode_line_full. This is the |
| default function for the `decode_location' method of breakpoint_ops. */ |
| |
| static std::vector<symtab_and_line> |
| decode_location_default (struct breakpoint *b, |
| struct event_location *location, |
| struct program_space *search_pspace) |
| { |
| struct linespec_result canonical; |
| |
| decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, search_pspace, |
| NULL, 0, &canonical, multiple_symbols_all, |
| b->filter.get ()); |
| |
| /* We should get 0 or 1 resulting SALs. */ |
| gdb_assert (canonical.lsals.size () < 2); |
| |
| if (!canonical.lsals.empty ()) |
| { |
| const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0]; |
| return std::move (lsal.sals); |
| } |
| return {}; |
| } |
| |
| /* Reset a breakpoint. */ |
| |
| static void |
| breakpoint_re_set_one (breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| input_radix = b->input_radix; |
| set_language (b->language); |
| |
| b->re_set (); |
| } |
| |
| /* Re-set breakpoint locations for the current program space. |
| Locations bound to other program spaces are left untouched. */ |
| |
| void |
| breakpoint_re_set (void) |
| { |
| { |
| scoped_restore_current_language save_language; |
| scoped_restore save_input_radix = make_scoped_restore (&input_radix); |
| scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread; |
| |
| /* breakpoint_re_set_one sets the current_language to the language |
| of the breakpoint it is resetting (see prepare_re_set_context) |
| before re-evaluating the breakpoint's location. This change can |
| unfortunately get undone by accident if the language_mode is set |
| to auto, and we either switch frames, or more likely in this context, |
| we select the current frame. |
| |
| We prevent this by temporarily turning the language_mode to |
| language_mode_manual. We restore it once all breakpoints |
| have been reset. */ |
| scoped_restore save_language_mode = make_scoped_restore (&language_mode); |
| language_mode = language_mode_manual; |
| |
| /* Note: we must not try to insert locations until after all |
| breakpoints have been re-set. Otherwise, e.g., when re-setting |
| breakpoint 1, we'd insert the locations of breakpoint 2, which |
| hadn't been re-set yet, and thus may have stale locations. */ |
| |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) |
| { |
| try |
| { |
| breakpoint_re_set_one (b); |
| } |
| catch (const gdb_exception &ex) |
| { |
| exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex, |
| "Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ", |
| b->number); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| jit_breakpoint_re_set (); |
| } |
| |
| create_overlay_event_breakpoint (); |
| create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (); |
| create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (); |
| create_exception_master_breakpoint (); |
| |
| /* Now we can insert. */ |
| update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); |
| } |
| |
| /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint: |
| |
| - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is. |
| - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */ |
| void |
| breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| if (b->thread != -1) |
| { |
| b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num; |
| |
| /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is |
| selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a |
| different program space from the original thread. Reset that |
| as well. */ |
| b->loc->pspace = current_program_space; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT. |
| If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect, |
| which ends with a period (no newline). */ |
| |
| void |
| set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty) |
| { |
| if (count < 0) |
| count = 0; |
| |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| if (b->number == bptnum) |
| { |
| if (is_tracepoint (b)) |
| { |
| if (from_tty && count != 0) |
| gdb_printf (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."), |
| bptnum); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| b->ignore_count = count; |
| if (from_tty) |
| { |
| if (count == 0) |
| gdb_printf (_("Will stop next time " |
| "breakpoint %d is reached."), |
| bptnum); |
| else if (count == 1) |
| gdb_printf (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."), |
| bptnum); |
| else |
| gdb_printf (_("Will ignore next %d " |
| "crossings of breakpoint %d."), |
| count, bptnum); |
| } |
| gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum); |
| } |
| |
| /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */ |
| |
| static void |
| ignore_command (const char *args, int from_tty) |
| { |
| const char *p = args; |
| int num; |
| |
| if (p == 0) |
| error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number")); |
| |
| num = get_number (&p); |
| if (num == 0) |
| error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args); |
| if (*p == 0) |
| error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing.")); |
| |
| set_ignore_count (num, |
| longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))), |
| from_tty); |
| if (from_tty) |
| gdb_printf ("\n"); |
| } |
| |
| |
| /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints with numbers in the range |
| defined by BP_NUM_RANGE (an inclusive range). */ |
| |
| static void |
| map_breakpoint_number_range (std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range, |
| gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function) |
| { |
| if (bp_num_range.first == 0) |
| { |
| warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%d'"), |
| bp_num_range.first); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| for (int i = bp_num_range.first; i <= bp_num_range.second; i++) |
| { |
| bool match = false; |
| |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) |
| if (b->number == i) |
| { |
| match = true; |
| function (b); |
| break; |
| } |
| if (!match) |
| gdb_printf (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), i); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints whose numbers are given in |
| ARGS. */ |
| |
| static void |
| map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *args, |
| gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function) |
| { |
| if (args == NULL || *args == '\0') |
| error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers")); |
| |
| number_or_range_parser parser (args); |
| |
| while (!parser.finished ()) |
| { |
| int num = parser.get_number (); |
| map_breakpoint_number_range (std::make_pair (num, num), function); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Return the breakpoint location structure corresponding to the |
| BP_NUM and LOC_NUM values. */ |
| |
| static struct bp_location * |
| find_location_by_number (int bp_num, int loc_num) |
| { |
| breakpoint *b = get_breakpoint (bp_num); |
| |
| if (!b || b->number != bp_num) |
| error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%d'"), bp_num); |
| |
| if (loc_num == 0) |
| error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num); |
| |
| int n = 0; |
| for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ()) |
| if (++n == loc_num) |
| return loc; |
| |
| error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num); |
| } |
| |
| /* Modes of operation for extract_bp_num. */ |
| enum class extract_bp_kind |
| { |
| /* Extracting a breakpoint number. */ |
| bp, |
| |
| /* Extracting a location number. */ |
| loc, |
| }; |
| |
| /* Extract a breakpoint or location number (as determined by KIND) |
| from the string starting at START. TRAILER is a character which |
| can be found after the number. If you don't want a trailer, use |
| '\0'. If END_OUT is not NULL, it is set to point after the parsed |
| string. This always returns a positive integer. */ |
| |
| static int |
| extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind kind, const char *start, |
| int trailer, const char **end_out = NULL) |
| { |
| const char *end = start; |
| int num = get_number_trailer (&end, trailer); |
| if (num < 0) |
| error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp |
| ? _("Negative breakpoint number '%.*s'") |
| : _("Negative breakpoint location number '%.*s'"), |
| int (end - start), start); |
| if (num == 0) |
| error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp |
| ? _("Bad breakpoint number '%.*s'") |
| : _("Bad breakpoint location number '%.*s'"), |
| int (end - start), start); |
| |
| if (end_out != NULL) |
| *end_out = end; |
| return num; |
| } |
| |
| /* Extract a breakpoint or location range (as determined by KIND) in |
| the form NUM1-NUM2 stored at &ARG[arg_offset]. Returns a std::pair |
| representing the (inclusive) range. The returned pair's elements |
| are always positive integers. */ |
| |
| static std::pair<int, int> |
| extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind kind, |
| const std::string &arg, |
| std::string::size_type arg_offset) |
| { |
| std::pair<int, int> range; |
| const char *bp_loc = &arg[arg_offset]; |
| std::string::size_type dash = arg.find ('-', arg_offset); |
| if (dash != std::string::npos) |
| { |
| /* bp_loc is a range (x-z). */ |
| if (arg.length () == dash + 1) |
| error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp |
| ? _("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'") |
| : _("Bad breakpoint location number at or near: '%s'"), |
| bp_loc); |
| |
| const char *end; |
| const char *start_first = bp_loc; |
| const char *start_second = &arg[dash + 1]; |
| range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, start_first, '-'); |
| range.second = extract_bp_num (kind, start_second, '\0', &end); |
| |
| if (range.first > range.second) |
| error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp |
| ? _("Inverted breakpoint range at '%.*s'") |
| : _("Inverted breakpoint location range at '%.*s'"), |
| int (end - start_first), start_first); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* bp_loc is a single value. */ |
| range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, bp_loc, '\0'); |
| range.second = range.first; |
| } |
| return range; |
| } |
| |
| /* Extract the breakpoint/location range specified by ARG. Returns |
| the breakpoint range in BP_NUM_RANGE, and the location range in |
| BP_LOC_RANGE. |
| |
| ARG may be in any of the following forms: |
| |
| x where 'x' is a breakpoint number. |
| x-y where 'x' and 'y' specify a breakpoint numbers range. |
| x.y where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' a location number. |
| x.y-z where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' and 'z' specify a |
| location number range. |
| */ |
| |
| static void |
| extract_bp_number_and_location (const std::string &arg, |
| std::pair<int, int> &bp_num_range, |
| std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range) |
| { |
| std::string::size_type dot = arg.find ('.'); |
| |
| if (dot != std::string::npos) |
| { |
| /* Handle 'x.y' and 'x.y-z' cases. */ |
| |
| if (arg.length () == dot + 1 || dot == 0) |
| error (_("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'"), arg.c_str ()); |
| |
| bp_num_range.first |
| = extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg.c_str (), '.'); |
| bp_num_range.second = bp_num_range.first; |
| |
| bp_loc_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::loc, |
| arg, dot + 1); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* Handle x and x-y cases. */ |
| |
| bp_num_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg, 0); |
| bp_loc_range.first = 0; |
| bp_loc_range.second = 0; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Enable or disable a breakpoint location BP_NUM.LOC_NUM. ENABLE |
| specifies whether to enable or disable. */ |
| |
| static void |
| enable_disable_bp_num_loc (int bp_num, int loc_num, bool enable) |
| { |
| struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (bp_num, loc_num); |
| if (loc != NULL) |
| { |
| if (loc->disabled_by_cond && enable) |
| error (_("Breakpoint %d's condition is invalid at location %d, " |
| "cannot enable."), bp_num, loc_num); |
| |
| if (loc->enabled != enable) |
| { |
| loc->enabled = enable; |
| mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc); |
| } |
| if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint () |
| && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner |
| && is_tracepoint (loc->owner)) |
| target_disable_tracepoint (loc); |
| } |
| update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); |
| |
| gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (loc->owner); |
| } |
| |
| /* Enable or disable a range of breakpoint locations. BP_NUM is the |
| number of the breakpoint, and BP_LOC_RANGE specifies the |
| (inclusive) range of location numbers of that breakpoint to |
| enable/disable. ENABLE specifies whether to enable or disable the |
| location. */ |
| |
| static void |
| enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range (int bp_num, |
| std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range, |
| bool enable) |
| { |
| for (int i = bp_loc_range.first; i <= bp_loc_range.second; i++) |
| enable_disable_bp_num_loc (bp_num, i, enable); |
| } |
| |
| /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT. |
| If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect, |
| which ends with a period (no newline). */ |
| |
| void |
| disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt) |
| { |
| /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to |
| hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the |
| watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */ |
| if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope) |
| return; |
| |
| bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled; |
| |
| /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */ |
| mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt); |
| |
| if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint () |
| && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt)) |
| { |
| for (bp_location *location : bpt->locations ()) |
| target_disable_tracepoint (location); |
| } |
| |
| update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); |
| |
| gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bpt); |
| } |
| |
| /* Enable or disable the breakpoint(s) or breakpoint location(s) |
| specified in ARGS. ARGS may be in any of the formats handled by |
| extract_bp_number_and_location. ENABLE specifies whether to enable |
| or disable the breakpoints/locations. */ |
| |
| static void |
| enable_disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty, bool enable) |
| { |
| if (args == 0) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *bpt : all_breakpoints ()) |
| if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt)) |
| { |
| if (enable) |
| enable_breakpoint (bpt); |
| else |
| disable_breakpoint (bpt); |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| std::string num = extract_arg (&args); |
| |
| while (!num.empty ()) |
| { |
| std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range, bp_loc_range; |
| |
| extract_bp_number_and_location (num, bp_num_range, bp_loc_range); |
| |
| if (bp_loc_range.first == bp_loc_range.second |
| && bp_loc_range.first == 0) |
| { |
| /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x' or 'x-z'. */ |
| map_breakpoint_number_range (bp_num_range, |
| enable |
| ? enable_breakpoint |
| : disable_breakpoint); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x.y' or |
| 'x.y-z'. */ |
| enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range |
| (bp_num_range.first, bp_loc_range, enable); |
| } |
| num = extract_arg (&args); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* The disable command disables the specified breakpoints/locations |
| (or all defined breakpoints) so they're no longer effective in |
| stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the forms defined in |
| extract_bp_number_and_location. */ |
| |
| static void |
| disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty) |
| { |
| enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, false); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition, |
| int count) |
| { |
| int target_resources_ok; |
| |
| if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint) |
| { |
| int i; |
| i = hw_breakpoint_used_count (); |
| target_resources_ok = |
| target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint, |
| i + 1, 0); |
| if (target_resources_ok == 0) |
| error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target.")); |
| else if (target_resources_ok < 0) |
| error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit.")); |
| } |
| |
| if (is_watchpoint (bpt)) |
| { |
| /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */ |
| enum enable_state orig_enable_state = bp_disabled; |
| |
| try |
| { |
| struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt; |
| |
| orig_enable_state = bpt->enable_state; |
| bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled; |
| update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */); |
| } |
| catch (const gdb_exception &e) |
| { |
| bpt->enable_state = orig_enable_state; |
| exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "), |
| bpt->number); |
| return; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled; |
| |
| /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */ |
| mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt); |
| |
| if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint () |
| && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt)) |
| { |
| for (bp_location *location : bpt->locations ()) |
| target_enable_tracepoint (location); |
| } |
| |
| bpt->disposition = disposition; |
| bpt->enable_count = count; |
| update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); |
| |
| gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bpt); |
| } |
| |
| |
| void |
| enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt) |
| { |
| enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, bpt->disposition, 0); |
| } |
| |
| /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints/locations (or |
| all defined breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to |
| be) effective in stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the |
| forms defined in extract_bp_number_and_location. */ |
| |
| static void |
| enable_command (const char *args, int from_tty) |
| { |
| enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, true); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| enable_once_command (const char *args, int from_tty) |
| { |
| map_breakpoint_numbers |
| (args, [&] (breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| iterate_over_related_breakpoints |
| (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt) |
| { |
| enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, 1); |
| }); |
| }); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| enable_count_command (const char *args, int from_tty) |
| { |
| int count; |
| |
| if (args == NULL) |
| error_no_arg (_("hit count")); |
| |
| count = get_number (&args); |
| |
| map_breakpoint_numbers |
| (args, [&] (breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| iterate_over_related_breakpoints |
| (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt) |
| { |
| enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, count); |
| }); |
| }); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| enable_delete_command (const char *args, int from_tty) |
| { |
| map_breakpoint_numbers |
| (args, [&] (breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| iterate_over_related_breakpoints |
| (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt) |
| { |
| enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_del, 1); |
| }); |
| }); |
| } |
| |
| /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if |
| the memory which that value represents has been written to by |
| GDB itself. */ |
| |
| static void |
| invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (struct inferior *inferior, |
| CORE_ADDR addr, ssize_t len, |
| const bfd_byte *data) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *bp : all_breakpoints ()) |
| if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled |
| && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint) |
| { |
| struct watchpoint *wp = (struct watchpoint *) bp; |
| |
| if (wp->val_valid && wp->val != nullptr) |
| { |
| for (bp_location *loc : bp->locations ()) |
| if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint |
| && loc->address + loc->length > addr |
| && addr + len > loc->address) |
| { |
| wp->val = NULL; |
| wp->val_valid = false; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */ |
| |
| void |
| insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, |
| const address_space *aspace, |
| CORE_ADDR next_pc) |
| { |
| struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread (); |
| struct symtab_and_line sal; |
| CORE_ADDR pc = next_pc; |
| |
| if (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints == NULL) |
| { |
| std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b |
| (new momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_single_step)); |
| |
| b->disposition = disp_donttouch; |
| |
| b->thread = tp->global_num; |
| gdb_assert (b->thread != 0); |
| |
| tp->control.single_step_breakpoints |
| = add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b)); |
| } |
| |
| sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0); |
| sal.pc = pc; |
| sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc); |
| sal.explicit_pc = 1; |
| |
| auto *ss_bp |
| = static_cast<momentary_breakpoint *> (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints); |
| ss_bp->add_location (sal); |
| |
| update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT); |
| } |
| |
| /* Insert single step breakpoints according to the current state. */ |
| |
| int |
| insert_single_step_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch) |
| { |
| struct regcache *regcache = get_current_regcache (); |
| std::vector<CORE_ADDR> next_pcs; |
| |
| next_pcs = gdbarch_software_single_step (gdbarch, regcache); |
| |
| if (!next_pcs.empty ()) |
| { |
| struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame (); |
| const address_space *aspace = get_frame_address_space (frame); |
| |
| for (CORE_ADDR pc : next_pcs) |
| insert_single_step_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, pc); |
| |
| return 1; |
| } |
| else |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| int |
| breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (struct breakpoint *bp, |
| const address_space *aspace, |
| CORE_ADDR pc) |
| { |
| for (bp_location *loc : bp->locations ()) |
| if (loc->inserted |
| && breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc)) |
| return 1; |
| |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at |
| PC. */ |
| |
| int |
| single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace, |
| CORE_ADDR pc) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *bpt : all_breakpoints ()) |
| { |
| if (bpt->type == bp_single_step |
| && breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (bpt, aspace, pc)) |
| return 1; |
| } |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */ |
| |
| /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */ |
| static void |
| set_tracepoint_count (int num) |
| { |
| tracepoint_count = num; |
| set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) |
| { |
| event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, |
| current_language); |
| const struct breakpoint_ops *ops = breakpoint_ops_for_event_location |
| (location.get (), true /* is_tracepoint */); |
| |
| create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), |
| location.get (), |
| NULL, 0, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */, |
| 0 /* tempflag */, |
| bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */, |
| 0 /* Ignore count */, |
| pending_break_support, |
| ops, |
| from_tty, |
| 1 /* enabled */, |
| 0 /* internal */, 0); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| ftrace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) |
| { |
| event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, |
| current_language); |
| create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), |
| location.get (), |
| NULL, 0, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */, |
| 0 /* tempflag */, |
| bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */, |
| 0 /* Ignore count */, |
| pending_break_support, |
| &base_breakpoint_ops, |
| from_tty, |
| 1 /* enabled */, |
| 0 /* internal */, 0); |
| } |
| |
| /* strace command implementation. Creates a static tracepoint. */ |
| |
| static void |
| strace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) |
| { |
| const struct breakpoint_ops *ops; |
| event_location_up location; |
| enum bptype type; |
| |
| /* Decide if we are dealing with a static tracepoint marker (`-m'), |
| or with a normal static tracepoint. */ |
| if (arg && startswith (arg, "-m") && isspace (arg[2])) |
| { |
| ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops; |
| location = new_linespec_location (&arg, symbol_name_match_type::FULL); |
| type = bp_static_marker_tracepoint; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| ops = &base_breakpoint_ops; |
| location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language); |
| type = bp_static_tracepoint; |
| } |
| |
| create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), |
| location.get (), |
| NULL, 0, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */, |
| 0 /* tempflag */, |
| type /* type_wanted */, |
| 0 /* Ignore count */, |
| pending_break_support, |
| ops, |
| from_tty, |
| 1 /* enabled */, |
| 0 /* internal */, 0); |
| } |
| |
| /* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked |
| list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading. */ |
| |
| static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp; |
| static int next_cmd; |
| |
| static char * |
| read_uploaded_action (void) |
| { |
| char *rslt = nullptr; |
| |
| if (next_cmd < this_utp->cmd_strings.size ()) |
| { |
| rslt = this_utp->cmd_strings[next_cmd].get (); |
| next_cmd++; |
| } |
| |
| return rslt; |
| } |
| |
| /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which |
| can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an |
| equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since |
| the target does not necessarily have all the information used when |
| the tracepoint was originally defined. */ |
| |
| struct tracepoint * |
| create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp) |
| { |
| const char *addr_str; |
| char small_buf[100]; |
| struct tracepoint *tp; |
| |
| if (utp->at_string) |
| addr_str = utp->at_string.get (); |
| else |
| { |
| /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw |
| address. Since there is no way to confirm that the address |
| means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the |
| user. */ |
| warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no " |
| "source location, using raw address"), |
| utp->number); |
| xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr)); |
| addr_str = small_buf; |
| } |
| |
| /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes. */ |
| if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string) |
| warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition " |
| "has no source form, ignoring it"), |
| utp->number); |
| |
| event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&addr_str, |
| current_language); |
| if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), |
| location.get (), |
| utp->cond_string.get (), -1, addr_str, |
| false /* force_condition */, |
| 0 /* parse cond/thread */, |
| 0 /* tempflag */, |
| utp->type /* type_wanted */, |
| 0 /* Ignore count */, |
| pending_break_support, |
| &base_breakpoint_ops, |
| 0 /* from_tty */, |
| utp->enabled /* enabled */, |
| 0 /* internal */, |
| CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED)) |
| return NULL; |
| |
| /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */ |
| tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count); |
| gdb_assert (tp != NULL); |
| |
| if (utp->pass > 0) |
| { |
| xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "%d %d", utp->pass, |
| tp->number); |
| |
| trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0); |
| } |
| |
| /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a |
| special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line |
| reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting |
| function. */ |
| if (!utp->cmd_strings.empty ()) |
| { |
| counted_command_line cmd_list; |
| |
| this_utp = utp; |
| next_cmd = 0; |
| |
| cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL); |
| |
| breakpoint_set_commands (tp, std::move (cmd_list)); |
| } |
| else if (!utp->actions.empty () |
| || !utp->step_actions.empty ()) |
| warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions " |
| "have no source form, ignoring them"), |
| utp->number); |
| |
| /* Copy any status information that might be available. */ |
| tp->hit_count = utp->hit_count; |
| tp->traceframe_usage = utp->traceframe_usage; |
| |
| return tp; |
| } |
| |
| /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if |
| omitted. */ |
| |
| static void |
| info_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty) |
| { |
| struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; |
| int num_printed; |
| |
| num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, false, is_tracepoint); |
| |
| if (num_printed == 0) |
| { |
| if (args == NULL || *args == '\0') |
| uiout->message ("No tracepoints.\n"); |
| else |
| uiout->message ("No tracepoint matching '%s'.\n", args); |
| } |
| |
| default_collect_info (); |
| } |
| |
| /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints. |
| Not supported by all targets. */ |
| static void |
| enable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty) |
| { |
| enable_command (args, from_tty); |
| } |
| |
| /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints. |
| Not supported by all targets. */ |
| static void |
| disable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty) |
| { |
| disable_command (args, from_tty); |
| } |
| |
| /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument). */ |
| static void |
| delete_trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) |
| { |
| dont_repeat (); |
| |
| if (arg == 0) |
| { |
| int breaks_to_delete = 0; |
| |
| /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument. |
| Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these |
| have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number |
| argument. */ |
| for (breakpoint *tp : all_tracepoints ()) |
| if (is_tracepoint (tp) && user_breakpoint_p (tp)) |
| { |
| breaks_to_delete = 1; |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */ |
| if (!from_tty |
| || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? ")))) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) |
| if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b)) |
| delete_breakpoint (b); |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| map_breakpoint_numbers |
| (arg, [&] (breakpoint *br) |
| { |
| iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br, delete_breakpoint); |
| }); |
| } |
| |
| /* Helper function for trace_pass_command. */ |
| |
| static void |
| trace_pass_set_count (struct tracepoint *tp, int count, int from_tty) |
| { |
| tp->pass_count = count; |
| gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (tp); |
| if (from_tty) |
| gdb_printf (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"), |
| tp->number, count); |
| } |
| |
| /* Set passcount for tracepoint. |
| |
| First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number. |
| If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined. |
| Also accepts special argument "all". */ |
| |
| static void |
| trace_pass_command (const char *args, int from_tty) |
| { |
| struct tracepoint *t1; |
| ULONGEST count; |
| |
| if (args == 0 || *args == 0) |
| error (_("passcount command requires an " |
| "argument (count + optional TP num)")); |
| |
| count = strtoulst (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */ |
| |
| args = skip_spaces (args); |
| if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0) |
| { |
| args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */ |
| if (*args) |
| error (_("Junk at end of arguments.")); |
| |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_tracepoints ()) |
| { |
| t1 = (struct tracepoint *) b; |
| trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty); |
| } |
| } |
| else if (*args == '\0') |
| { |
| t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, NULL); |
| if (t1) |
| trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| number_or_range_parser parser (args); |
| while (!parser.finished ()) |
| { |
| t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, &parser); |
| if (t1) |
| trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| struct tracepoint * |
| get_tracepoint (int num) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *t : all_tracepoints ()) |
| if (t->number == num) |
| return (struct tracepoint *) t; |
| |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| |
| /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be |
| different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and |
| reconnecting). */ |
| |
| struct tracepoint * |
| get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_tracepoints ()) |
| { |
| struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b; |
| |
| if (t->number_on_target == num) |
| return t; |
| } |
| |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| |
| /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list. |
| If STATE is not NULL, use, get_number_or_range_state and ignore ARG. |
| If the argument is missing, the most recent tracepoint |
| (tracepoint_count) is returned. */ |
| |
| struct tracepoint * |
| get_tracepoint_by_number (const char **arg, |
| number_or_range_parser *parser) |
| { |
| int tpnum; |
| const char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg; |
| |
| if (parser != NULL) |
| { |
| gdb_assert (!parser->finished ()); |
| tpnum = parser->get_number (); |
| } |
| else if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg) |
| tpnum = tracepoint_count; |
| else |
| tpnum = get_number (arg); |
| |
| if (tpnum <= 0) |
| { |
| if (instring && *instring) |
| gdb_printf (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"), |
| instring); |
| else |
| gdb_printf (_("No previous tracepoint\n")); |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| |
| for (breakpoint *t : all_tracepoints ()) |
| if (t->number == tpnum) |
| return (struct tracepoint *) t; |
| |
| gdb_printf ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum); |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| breakpoint::print_recreate_thread (struct ui_file *fp) const |
| { |
| if (thread != -1) |
| gdb_printf (fp, " thread %d", thread); |
| |
| if (task != 0) |
| gdb_printf (fp, " task %d", task); |
| |
| gdb_printf (fp, "\n"); |
| } |
| |
| /* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to |
| a new script file named FILENAME. If FILTER is non-NULL, call it |
| on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns |
| true. */ |
| |
| static void |
| save_breakpoints (const char *filename, int from_tty, |
| bool (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *)) |
| { |
| int any = 0; |
| int extra_trace_bits = 0; |
| |
| if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0) |
| error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)")); |
| |
| /* See if we have anything to save. */ |
| for (breakpoint *tp : all_breakpoints ()) |
| { |
| /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */ |
| if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp)) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */ |
| if (filter && !filter (tp)) |
| continue; |
| |
| any = 1; |
| |
| if (is_tracepoint (tp)) |
| { |
| extra_trace_bits = 1; |
| |
| /* We can stop searching. */ |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (!any) |
| { |
| warning (_("Nothing to save.")); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> expanded_filename (tilde_expand (filename)); |
| |
| stdio_file fp; |
| |
| if (!fp.open (expanded_filename.get (), "w")) |
| error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"), |
| expanded_filename.get (), safe_strerror (errno)); |
| |
| if (extra_trace_bits) |
| save_trace_state_variables (&fp); |
| |
| for (breakpoint *tp : all_breakpoints ()) |
| { |
| /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */ |
| if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp)) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */ |
| if (filter && !filter (tp)) |
| continue; |
| |
| tp->print_recreate (&fp); |
| |
| /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't |
| assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match. Use $bpnum |
| instead. */ |
| |
| if (tp->cond_string) |
| fp.printf (" condition $bpnum %s\n", tp->cond_string.get ()); |
| |
| if (tp->ignore_count) |
| fp.printf (" ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp->ignore_count); |
| |
| if (tp->type != bp_dprintf && tp->commands) |
| { |
| fp.puts (" commands\n"); |
| |
| current_uiout->redirect (&fp); |
| try |
| { |
| print_command_lines (current_uiout, tp->commands.get (), 2); |
| } |
| catch (const gdb_exception &ex) |
| { |
| current_uiout->redirect (NULL); |
| throw; |
| } |
| |
| current_uiout->redirect (NULL); |
| fp.puts (" end\n"); |
| } |
| |
| if (tp->enable_state == bp_disabled) |
| fp.puts ("disable $bpnum\n"); |
| |
| /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations |
| should be individually disabled. Watchpoint locations are |
| special, and not user visible. */ |
| if (!is_watchpoint (tp) && tp->loc && tp->loc->next) |
| { |
| int n = 1; |
| |
| for (bp_location *loc : tp->locations ()) |
| { |
| if (!loc->enabled) |
| fp.printf ("disable $bpnum.%d\n", n); |
| |
| n++; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (extra_trace_bits && !default_collect.empty ()) |
| fp.printf ("set default-collect %s\n", default_collect.c_str ()); |
| |
| if (from_tty) |
| gdb_printf (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), expanded_filename.get ()); |
| } |
| |
| /* The `save breakpoints' command. */ |
| |
| static void |
| save_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty) |
| { |
| save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL); |
| } |
| |
| /* The `save tracepoints' command. */ |
| |
| static void |
| save_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty) |
| { |
| save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint); |
| } |
| |
| |
| /* This help string is used to consolidate all the help string for specifying |
| locations used by several commands. */ |
| |
| #define LOCATION_HELP_STRING \ |
| "Linespecs are colon-separated lists of location parameters, such as\n\ |
| source filename, function name, label name, and line number.\n\ |
| Example: To specify the start of a label named \"the_top\" in the\n\ |
| function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use\n\ |
| \"factorial.c:fact:the_top\".\n\ |
| \n\ |
| Address locations begin with \"*\" and specify an exact address in the\n\ |
| program. Example: To specify the fourth byte past the start function\n\ |
| \"main\", use \"*main + 4\".\n\ |
| \n\ |
| Explicit locations are similar to linespecs but use an option/argument\n\ |
| syntax to specify location parameters.\n\ |
| Example: To specify the start of the label named \"the_top\" in the\n\ |
| function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use \"-source factorial.c\n\ |
| -function fact -label the_top\".\n\ |
| \n\ |
| By default, a specified function is matched against the program's\n\ |
| functions in all scopes. For C++, this means in all namespaces and\n\ |
| classes. For Ada, this means in all packages. E.g., in C++,\n\ |
| \"func()\" matches \"A::func()\", \"A::B::func()\", etc. The\n\ |
| \"-qualified\" flag overrides this behavior, making GDB interpret the\n\ |
| specified name as a complete fully-qualified name instead." |
| |
| /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak |
| commands. It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication. |
| COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the |
| command. */ |
| |
| #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \ |
| command" [PROBE_MODIFIER] [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM]\n\ |
| \t[-force-condition] [if CONDITION]\n\ |
| PROBE_MODIFIER shall be present if the command is to be placed in a\n\ |
| probe point. Accepted values are `-probe' (for a generic, automatically\n\ |
| guessed probe type), `-probe-stap' (for a SystemTap probe) or \n\ |
| `-probe-dtrace' (for a DTrace probe).\n\ |
| LOCATION may be a linespec, address, or explicit location as described\n\ |
| below.\n\ |
| \n\ |
| With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\ |
| stack frame. This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\ |
| \n\ |
| THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\ |
| CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\ |
| \n\ |
| With the \"-force-condition\" flag, the condition is defined even when\n\ |
| it is invalid for all current locations.\n\ |
| \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\n\ |
| Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\ |
| conditions are different.\n\ |
| \n\ |
| Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints." |
| |
| /* List of subcommands for "catch". */ |
| static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist; |
| |
| /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */ |
| static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist; |
| |
| void |
| add_catch_command (const char *name, const char *docstring, |
| cmd_func_ftype *func, |
| completer_ftype *completer, |
| void *user_data_catch, |
| void *user_data_tcatch) |
| { |
| struct cmd_list_element *command; |
| |
| command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring, |
| &catch_cmdlist); |
| command->func = func; |
| command->set_context (user_data_catch); |
| set_cmd_completer (command, completer); |
| |
| command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring, |
| &tcatch_cmdlist); |
| command->func = func; |
| command->set_context (user_data_tcatch); |
| set_cmd_completer (command, completer); |
| } |
| |
| /* Zero if any of the breakpoint's locations could be a location where |
| functions have been inlined, nonzero otherwise. */ |
| |
| static int |
| is_non_inline_function (struct breakpoint *b) |
| { |
| /* The shared library event breakpoint is set on the address of a |
| non-inline function. */ |
| if (b->type == bp_shlib_event) |
| return 1; |
| |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Nonzero if the specified PC cannot be a location where functions |
| have been inlined. */ |
| |
| int |
| pc_at_non_inline_function (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc, |
| const target_waitstatus &ws) |
| { |
| for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ()) |
| { |
| if (!is_non_inline_function (b)) |
| continue; |
| |
| for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ()) |
| { |
| if (!bl->shlib_disabled |
| && bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, pc, ws)) |
| return 1; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Remove any references to OBJFILE which is going to be freed. */ |
| |
| void |
| breakpoint_free_objfile (struct objfile *objfile) |
| { |
| for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ()) |
| if (loc->symtab != NULL && loc->symtab->compunit ()->objfile () == objfile) |
| loc->symtab = NULL; |
| } |
| |
| /* Chain containing all defined "enable breakpoint" subcommands. */ |
| |
| static struct cmd_list_element *enablebreaklist = NULL; |
| |
| /* See breakpoint.h. */ |
| |
| cmd_list_element *commands_cmd_element = nullptr; |
| |
| void _initialize_breakpoint (); |
| void |
| _initialize_breakpoint () |
| { |
| struct cmd_list_element *c; |
| |
| gdb::observers::solib_unloaded.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, |
| "breakpoint"); |
| gdb::observers::free_objfile.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile, |
| "breakpoint"); |
| gdb::observers::memory_changed.attach (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change, |
| "breakpoint"); |
| |
| breakpoint_chain = 0; |
| /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful |
| before a breakpoint is set. */ |
| breakpoint_count = 0; |
| |
| tracepoint_count = 0; |
| |
| add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\ |
| Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\ |
| Usage is `ignore N COUNT'.")); |
| |
| commands_cmd_element = add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, |
| commands_command, _("\ |
| Set commands to be executed when the given breakpoints are hit.\n\ |
| Give a space-separated breakpoint list as argument after \"commands\".\n\ |
| A list element can be a breakpoint number (e.g. `5') or a range of numbers\n\ |
| (e.g. `5-7').\n\ |
| With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\ |
| The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\ |
| Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\ |
| Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\ |
| then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print.")); |
| |
| const auto cc_opts = make_condition_command_options_def_group (nullptr); |
| static std::string condition_command_help |
| = gdb::option::build_help (_("\ |
| Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\ |
| Usage is `condition [OPTION] N COND', where N is an integer and COND\n\ |
| is an expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached.\n\ |
| \n\ |
| Options:\n\ |
| %OPTIONS%"), cc_opts); |
| |
| c = add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, |
| condition_command_help.c_str ()); |
| set_cmd_completer_handle_brkchars (c, condition_completer); |
| |
| c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\ |
| Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\ |
| Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\ |
| so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\ |
| by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\ |
| \n" |
| BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak"))); |
| set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); |
| |
| c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\ |
| Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\ |
| Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\ |
| some target hardware may not have this support.\n\ |
| \n" |
| BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak"))); |
| set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); |
| |
| c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\ |
| Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\ |
| Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\ |
| so it will be deleted when hit.\n\ |
| \n" |
| BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak"))); |
| set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); |
| |
| cmd_list_element *enable_cmd |
| = add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\ |
| Enable all or some breakpoints.\n\ |
| Usage: enable [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\ |
| Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\ |
| With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\ |
| This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\ |
| With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."), |
| &enablelist, 1, &cmdlist); |
| |
| add_com_alias ("en", enable_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); |
| |
| add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\ |
| Enable all or some breakpoints.\n\ |
| Usage: enable breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\ |
| Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\ |
| This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\ |
| May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\"."), |
| &enablebreaklist, 1, &enablelist); |
| |
| add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\ |
| Enable some breakpoints for one hit.\n\ |
| Usage: enable breakpoints once BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\ |
| If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."), |
| &enablebreaklist); |
| |
| add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\ |
| Enable some breakpoints and delete when hit.\n\ |
| Usage: enable breakpoints delete BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\ |
| If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."), |
| &enablebreaklist); |
| |
| add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\ |
| Enable some breakpoints for COUNT hits.\n\ |
| Usage: enable breakpoints count COUNT BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\ |
| If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\ |
| the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."), |
| &enablebreaklist); |
| |
| add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\ |
| Enable some breakpoints and delete when hit.\n\ |
| Usage: enable delete BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\ |
| If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."), |
| &enablelist); |
| |
| add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\ |
| Enable some breakpoints for one hit.\n\ |
| Usage: enable once BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\ |
| If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."), |
| &enablelist); |
| |
| add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\ |
| Enable some breakpoints for COUNT hits.\n\ |
| Usage: enable count COUNT BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\ |
| If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\ |
| the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."), |
| &enablelist); |
| |
| cmd_list_element *disable_cmd |
| = add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\ |
| Disable all or some breakpoints.\n\ |
| Usage: disable [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\ |
| Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\ |
| To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\ |
| A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."), |
| &disablelist, 1, &cmdlist); |
| add_com_alias ("dis", disable_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); |
| add_com_alias ("disa", disable_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); |
| |
| add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\ |
| Disable all or some breakpoints.\n\ |
| Usage: disable breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\ |
| Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\ |
| To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\ |
| A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled.\n\ |
| This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."), |
| &disablelist); |
| |
| cmd_list_element *delete_cmd |
| = add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\ |
| Delete all or some breakpoints.\n\ |
| Usage: delete [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\ |
| Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\ |
| To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\ |
| \n\ |
| Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects."), |
| &deletelist, 1, &cmdlist); |
| add_com_alias ("d", delete_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); |
| add_com_alias ("del", delete_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); |
| |
| add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\ |
| Delete all or some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\ |
| Usage: delete breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\ |
| Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\ |
| To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\ |
| This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."), |
| &deletelist); |
| |
| cmd_list_element *clear_cmd |
| = add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\ |
| Clear breakpoint at specified location.\n\ |
| Argument may be a linespec, explicit, or address location as described below.\n\ |
| \n\ |
| With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\ |
| is executing in.\n" |
| "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\n\ |
| See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number.")); |
| add_com_alias ("cl", clear_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); |
| |
| cmd_list_element *break_cmd |
| = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\ |
| Set breakpoint at specified location.\n" |
| BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break"))); |
| set_cmd_completer (break_cmd, location_completer); |
| |
| add_com_alias ("b", break_cmd, class_run, 1); |
| add_com_alias ("br", break_cmd, class_run, 1); |
| add_com_alias ("bre", break_cmd, class_run, 1); |
| add_com_alias ("brea", break_cmd, class_run, 1); |
| |
| cmd_list_element *info_breakpoints_cmd |
| = add_info ("breakpoints", info_breakpoints_command, _("\ |
| Status of specified breakpoints (all user-settable breakpoints if no argument).\n\ |
| The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\ |
| \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\ |
| \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\ |
| The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\ |
| the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\ |
| breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\ |
| address and file/line number respectively.\n\ |
| \n\ |
| Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\ |
| are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\ |
| is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\ |
| Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\ |
| breakpoint set.")); |
| |
| add_info_alias ("b", info_breakpoints_cmd, 1); |
| |
| add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\ |
| Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\ |
| The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\ |
| \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\ |
| \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\ |
| \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\ |
| \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\ |
| \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\ |
| \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\ |
| The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\ |
| the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\ |
| breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\ |
| address and file/line number respectively.\n\ |
| \n\ |
| Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\ |
| are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\ |
| is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\ |
| Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\ |
| breakpoint set."), |
| &maintenanceinfolist); |
| |
| add_basic_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, _("\ |
| Set catchpoints to catch events."), |
| &catch_cmdlist, |
| 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist); |
| |
| add_basic_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, _("\ |
| Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."), |
| &tcatch_cmdlist, |
| 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist); |
| |
| const auto opts = make_watch_options_def_group (nullptr); |
| |
| static const std::string watch_help = gdb::option::build_help (_("\ |
| Set a watchpoint for EXPRESSION.\n\ |
| Usage: watch [-location] EXPRESSION\n\ |
| \n\ |
| Options:\n\ |
| %OPTIONS%\n\ |
| \n\ |
| A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\ |
| an expression changes."), opts); |
| c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, |
| watch_help.c_str ()); |
| set_cmd_completer_handle_brkchars (c, watch_command_completer); |
| |
| static const std::string rwatch_help = gdb::option::build_help (_("\ |
| Set a read watchpoint for EXPRESSION.\n\ |
| Usage: rwatch [-location] EXPRESSION\n\ |
| \n\ |
| Options:\n\ |
| %OPTIONS%\n\ |
| \n\ |
| A read watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\ |
| an expression is read."), opts); |
| c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, |
| rwatch_help.c_str ()); |
| set_cmd_completer_handle_brkchars (c, watch_command_completer); |
| |
| static const std::string awatch_help = gdb::option::build_help (_("\ |
| Set an access watchpoint for EXPRESSION.\n\ |
| Usage: awatch [-location] EXPRESSION\n\ |
| \n\ |
| Options:\n\ |
| %OPTIONS%\n\ |
| \n\ |
| An access watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value\n\ |
| of an expression is either read or written."), opts); |
| c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, |
| awatch_help.c_str ()); |
| set_cmd_completer_handle_brkchars (c, watch_command_completer); |
| |
| add_info ("watchpoints", info_watchpoints_command, _("\ |
| Status of specified watchpoints (all watchpoints if no argument).")); |
| |
| /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should |
| respond to changes - contrary to the description. */ |
| add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support, |
| &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\ |
| Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\ |
| Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\ |
| If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\ |
| such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\ |
| created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\ |
| hardware.)"), |
| NULL, |
| show_can_use_hw_watchpoints, |
| &setlist, &showlist); |
| |
| can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1; |
| |
| /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */ |
| |
| cmd_list_element *trace_cmd |
| = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\ |
| Set a tracepoint at specified location.\n\ |
| \n" |
| BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\ |
| Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands.")); |
| set_cmd_completer (trace_cmd, location_completer); |
| |
| add_com_alias ("tp", trace_cmd, class_breakpoint, 0); |
| add_com_alias ("tr", trace_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); |
| add_com_alias ("tra", trace_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); |
| add_com_alias ("trac", trace_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); |
| |
| c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\ |
| Set a fast tracepoint at specified location.\n\ |
| \n" |
| BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\ |
| Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands.")); |
| set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); |
| |
| c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\ |
| Set a static tracepoint at location or marker.\n\ |
| \n\ |
| strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\ |
| LOCATION may be a linespec, explicit, or address location (described below) \n\ |
| or -m MARKER_ID.\n\n\ |
| If a marker id is specified, probe the marker with that name. With\n\ |
| no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected stack frame.\n\ |
| Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\ |
| This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\ |
| tracing library. You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\ |
| by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\ |
| \n\ |
| CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\ |
| \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\n\ |
| Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\ |
| conditions are different.\n\ |
| \n\ |
| Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\ |
| Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands.")); |
| set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); |
| |
| cmd_list_element *info_tracepoints_cmd |
| = add_info ("tracepoints", info_tracepoints_command, _("\ |
| Status of specified tracepoints (all tracepoints if no argument).\n\ |
| Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\ |
| last tracepoint set.")); |
| |
| add_info_alias ("tp", info_tracepoints_cmd, 1); |
| |
| cmd_list_element *delete_tracepoints_cmd |
| = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\ |
| Delete specified tracepoints.\n\ |
| Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\ |
| No argument means delete all tracepoints."), |
| &deletelist); |
| add_alias_cmd ("tr", delete_tracepoints_cmd, class_trace, 1, &deletelist); |
| |
| c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\ |
| Disable specified tracepoints.\n\ |
| Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\ |
| No argument means disable all tracepoints."), |
| &disablelist); |
| deprecate_cmd (c, "disable"); |
| |
| c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\ |
| Enable specified tracepoints.\n\ |
| Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\ |
| No argument means enable all tracepoints."), |
| &enablelist); |
| deprecate_cmd (c, "enable"); |
| |
| add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\ |
| Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\ |
| The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\ |
| Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\ |
| if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined.")); |
| |
| add_basic_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint, |
| _("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."), |
| &save_cmdlist, |
| 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist); |
| |
| c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\ |
| Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\ |
| This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\ |
| catchpoints, tracepoints). Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\ |
| session to restore them."), |
| &save_cmdlist); |
| set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer); |
| |
| cmd_list_element *save_tracepoints_cmd |
| = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\ |
| Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\ |
| Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."), |
| &save_cmdlist); |
| set_cmd_completer (save_tracepoints_cmd, filename_completer); |
| |
| c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", save_tracepoints_cmd, class_trace, 0); |
| deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints"); |
| |
| add_setshow_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, |
| _("\ |
| Breakpoint specific settings.\n\ |
| Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\ |
| pending breakpoint behavior."), |
| _("\ |
| Breakpoint specific settings.\n\ |
| Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\ |
| pending breakpoint behavior."), |
| &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, |
| &setlist, &showlist); |
| |
| add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class, |
| &pending_break_support, _("\ |
| Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\ |
| Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\ |
| If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\ |
| pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\ |
| an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\ |
| user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."), |
| NULL, |
| show_pending_break_support, |
| &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, |
| &breakpoint_show_cmdlist); |
| |
| pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO; |
| |
| add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class, |
| &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\ |
| Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\ |
| Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\ |
| If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\ |
| breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\ |
| a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."), |
| NULL, |
| show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints, |
| &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, |
| &breakpoint_show_cmdlist); |
| |
| add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support, |
| &always_inserted_mode, _("\ |
| Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\ |
| Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\ |
| When this mode is on, breakpoints are inserted immediately as soon as\n\ |
| they're created, kept inserted even when execution stops, and removed\n\ |
| only when the user deletes them. When this mode is off (the default),\n\ |
| breakpoints are inserted only when execution continues, and removed\n\ |
| when execution stops."), |
| NULL, |
| &show_always_inserted_mode, |
| &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, |
| &breakpoint_show_cmdlist); |
| |
| add_setshow_enum_cmd ("condition-evaluation", class_breakpoint, |
| condition_evaluation_enums, |
| &condition_evaluation_mode_1, _("\ |
| Set mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\ |
| Show mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\ |
| When this is set to \"host\", breakpoint conditions will be\n\ |
| evaluated on the host's side by GDB. When it is set to \"target\",\n\ |
| breakpoint conditions will be downloaded to the target (if the target\n\ |
| supports such feature) and conditions will be evaluated on the target's side.\n\ |
| If this is set to \"auto\" (default), this will be automatically set to\n\ |
| \"target\" if it supports condition evaluation, otherwise it will\n\ |
| be set to \"host\"."), |
| &set_condition_evaluation_mode, |
| &show_condition_evaluation_mode, |
| &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, |
| &breakpoint_show_cmdlist); |
| |
| add_com ("break-range", class_breakpoint, break_range_command, _("\ |
| Set a breakpoint for an address range.\n\ |
| break-range START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION\n\ |
| where START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION can be one of the following:\n\ |
| LINENUM, for that line in the current file,\n\ |
| FILE:LINENUM, for that line in that file,\n\ |
| +OFFSET, for that number of lines after the current line\n\ |
| or the start of the range\n\ |
| FUNCTION, for the first line in that function,\n\ |
| FILE:FUNCTION, to distinguish among like-named static functions.\n\ |
| *ADDRESS, for the instruction at that address.\n\ |
| \n\ |
| The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it executes\n\ |
| an instruction at any address within the [START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION]\n\ |
| range (including START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION).")); |
| |
| c = add_com ("dprintf", class_breakpoint, dprintf_command, _("\ |
| Set a dynamic printf at specified location.\n\ |
| dprintf location,format string,arg1,arg2,...\n\ |
| location may be a linespec, explicit, or address location.\n" |
| "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING)); |
| set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); |
| |
| add_setshow_enum_cmd ("dprintf-style", class_support, |
| dprintf_style_enums, &dprintf_style, _("\ |
| Set the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\ |
| Show the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\ |
| This setting chooses how GDB will do a dynamic printf.\n\ |
| If the value is \"gdb\", then the printing is done by GDB to its own\n\ |
| console, as with the \"printf\" command.\n\ |
| If the value is \"call\", the print is done by calling a function in your\n\ |
| program; by default printf(), but you can choose a different function or\n\ |
| output stream by setting dprintf-function and dprintf-channel."), |
| update_dprintf_commands, NULL, |
| &setlist, &showlist); |
| |
| add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-function", class_support, |
| &dprintf_function, _("\ |
| Set the function to use for dynamic printf."), _("\ |
| Show the function to use for dynamic printf."), NULL, |
| update_dprintf_commands, NULL, |
| &setlist, &showlist); |
| |
| add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-channel", class_support, |
| &dprintf_channel, _("\ |
| Set the channel to use for dynamic printf."), _("\ |
| Show the channel to use for dynamic printf."), NULL, |
| update_dprintf_commands, NULL, |
| &setlist, &showlist); |
| |
| add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("disconnected-dprintf", no_class, |
| &disconnected_dprintf, _("\ |
| Set whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\ |
| Show whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\ |
| Use this to let dprintf commands continue to hit and produce output\n\ |
| even if GDB disconnects or detaches from the target."), |
| NULL, |
| NULL, |
| &setlist, &showlist); |
| |
| add_com ("agent-printf", class_vars, agent_printf_command, _("\ |
| Target agent only formatted printing, like the C \"printf\" function.\n\ |
| Usage: agent-printf \"format string\", ARG1, ARG2, ARG3, ..., ARGN\n\ |
| This supports most C printf format specifications, like %s, %d, etc.\n\ |
| This is useful for formatted output in user-defined commands.")); |
| |
| automatic_hardware_breakpoints = true; |
| |
| gdb::observers::about_to_proceed.attach (breakpoint_about_to_proceed, |
| "breakpoint"); |
| gdb::observers::thread_exit.attach (remove_threaded_breakpoints, |
| "breakpoint"); |
| } |